A Creative Application of Traditionalist Aesthetics to the ...
Transcript of A Creative Application of Traditionalist Aesthetics to the ...
The University of Adelaide
Elder Conservatorium of Music
Faculty of Arts
A Creative Application of Traditionalist
Aesthetics to the Art of Musical Composition
by
Thomas Jack Devereux
Submitted in fulfillment of the requirements for the degree of
Master of Philosophy
(MPhil)
Adelaide, June 2018
1
Contents Abstract
Declaration
Acknowledgements
List of Musical Examples
Introduction
3
4
4
5
7
Chapter 1: History and Ideas of the Traditionalist School 18
Chapter 2: Application of the Ideas of the Traditionalist School to Musical Composition 29
Chapter 3: The Lights of Ibrahim 41
3.1: Score 42
3.2: Commentary 48
Chapter 4: Élivágar 58
4.1: Score 59
4.2: Commentary 91
Chapter 5: Road to the Heart 101
5.1: Score 102
5.2: Commentary 119
Chapter 6: Songs of Sorrow and Light 123
6.1: Score 124
6.2: Commentary 129
Chapter 7: Salve Regina 132
7.1: Score 133
7.2: Commentary 137
Conclusion 141
List of Sources 144
Appendix A: CD of Recordings
2
Abstract This submission for the degree of Master of Philosophy at the Elder Conservatorium of Music, University of Adelaide, takes the form of a portfolio of creative works (musical compositions) supported by an explanatory exegesis. The Traditionalist School, sometimes also called the perennialist school, was formed by a group of thinkers writing on a number of related topics, including the philosophy of art and aesthetics. The foundational written works of the school were published between 1921 and 1953. The portfolio explores the possibility of developing approaches to the composition of new works in accordance with the doctrinal and aesthetic principles of the Traditionalist School, in particular with the aesthetic philosophy of Frithjof Schuon, one of the founding members of the school. The exegesis explains the origins, central ideas, and aesthetic philosophy of the traditionalist school and proceeds to discuss the ways in which these can be taken as a starting point for developing a compositional approach. This requires a consideration both of general aesthetic concepts, as well as compositional techniques, although the folio focuses more on the former. The completed pieces take these concepts in different directions with each offering a different set of possibilities for further artistic exploration. The following works comprise the creative portfolio: The Lights of Ibrahim for piano trio; Elivagar for string quartet; Road to the Heart: song cycle for baritone and cello; Songs of Sorrow and Light: song cycle for tenor and piano; Salve Regina for SSAATB choir.
3
Declaration I certify that this work contains no material which has been accepted for the award of any other degree or diploma in my name, in any university or other tertiary institution and, to the best of my knowledge and belief, contains no material previously published or written by another person, except where due reference has been made in the text. In addition, I certify that no part of this work will, in the future, be used in a submission in my name, for any other degree or diploma in any university or other tertiary institution without the prior approval of the University of Adelaide and where applicable, any partner institution responsible for the joint-award of this degree. I give permission for the digital version of my thesis to be made available on the web, via the University’s digital research repository, the Library Search and also through web search engines, unless permission has been granted by the University to restrict access for a period of time. I acknowledge the support I have received for my research through the provision of an Australian Government Research Training Program Scholarship. Acknowledgments I would firstly like to acknowledge the work of the Endeavour Trio; Paul Dean, Trish O’Brien, and Stephen Emmerson, for the time they devoted to workshopping and performing The Lights of Ibrahim, as well as Diana Harris and the Accompanists’ Guild of South Australia for making this event possible. I would like to express my gratitude to my supervisor, Professor Charles Bodman Rae, for his support and guidance throughout my candidature. His ability to empathise, constructively criticise, and recognise potential pitfalls has been indispensable. I would also like to thank Professor Jennifer McMahon for her comments about philosophy and aesthetics and engagement with the early development of the topic, which was significant in defining the direction of the project. Finally I would like to thank family and friends who have supported me throughout this process. Signed Date:
14 June 2018
4
List of Musical Examples Ex. 3.1 The Lights of Ibrahim: Mode derived from harmonic series 48
Ex. 3.2 The Lights of Ibrahim: Minor mode 48
Ex. 3.3 The Lights of Ibrahim: Mode derived from 4ths 49
Ex. 3.4 The Lights of Ibrahim: Harmonies based on tritones and 4ths 50
Ex. 3.5 The Lights of Ibrahim: Tone row 50
Ex. 3.6 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A 52
Ex. 3.7 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A extension 52
Ex. 3.8 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A motif in inversion 53
Ex. 3.9 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A motif variation 53
Ex. 3.10 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A sequence 53
Ex. 3.11 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A in F sharp 54
Ex. 3.12 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A final movement variation 54
Ex. 3.13 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A sequence 54
Ex. 3.14 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme A variation 55
Ex. 3.15 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme B foreshadowing 55
Ex. 3.16 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme B 56
Ex. 3.17 The Lights of Ibrahim: Theme B variation 56
Ex. 3.18 The Lights of Ibrahim: Isorhythm 57
Ex. 4.1 Elivagar: Rhythmic mode 91
Ex. 4.2 Elivagar: Cross rhythm 9:4 91
Ex. 4.3 Elivagar: Cross rhythm 5:4 92
Ex. 4.4 Elivagar: Cross rhythm 9:4 variation 93
Ex. 4.5 Elivagar: Cross rhythm 7:4 93
Ex. 4.6 Elivagar: Cross rhythm 7:4 augmentation 93
Ex. 4.7 Elivagar: Asymmetrical rhythm 93
Ex. 4.8 Elivagar: Unmetered passage 94
Ex. 4.9 Elivagar: Free durations 94
Ex. 4.10 Elivagar: Folk-like violin part with 4:3 pattern in accompaniment 95
Ex. 4.11 Elivagar: Approximate 16:15 polyrhythm 96
Ex. 4.12 Elivagar: Three layer polyrhythm 96
Ex. 4.13 Elivagar: Rhythmically energised accompaniment 97
Ex. 4.14 Elivagar: Tremolo bowing 97
Ex. 4.15 Elivagar: Polyrhythm 3:4 98
5
Ex. 5.1 Road to the Heart: Pentatonic modes 120
Ex. 5.2 Road to the Heart: Rhythmic layers 121
Ex. 5.3 Road to the Heart: Non-octave mode 121
Ex. 5.4 Road to the Heart: Non-octave mode 121
Ex. 5.5 Road to the Heart: Organum style 1st species counterpoint 122
Ex. 5.6 Road to the Heart: Analysis of counterpoint 122
Ex. 6.1 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Theme 129
Ex. 6.2 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motifs A & B 129
Ex. 6.3 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motivic analysis 130
Ex. 6.4 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motivic analysis 130
Ex. 6.5 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motif C 131
Ex. 6.6 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Theme 131
Ex. 7.1 Salve Regina: Plainchant melody 137
Ex. 7.2 Salve Regina: Motif derived from plainchant 137
Ex. 7.3 Salve Regina: Two voice counterpoint 137
Ex. 7.4 Salve Regina: Canonic development of motif A 138
Ex. 7.5 Salve Regina: Secondary material 138
Ex. 7.6 Salve Regina: Canonic passage in B minor 139
Ex. 7.7 Salve Regina: Alternating male-female voices 140
Ex. 7.8 Salve Regina: Coda 140
6
Introduction
The art of musical composition; this term carries with it connotations arising from the European
musical tradition dating back to the beginning of the common practice period, and could be
extended to refer to the medieval origins of classical music and even to the music of Ancient
Greece which formed the basis of medieval musical theory. For the purposes of the following 1
essay, however, our definition must be expanded beyond the narrative of a single musical culture
and relatively brief period in musical history. Our terms of reference must be significantly
broader both in terms of historical scale and cultural boundaries. Here, then, musical
composition will be taken to mean the production of music, both in written and oral traditions,
across a range of human cultures dating back to the beginning of recorded history and extending
into pre-history, with the intention of discerning the principles which unite the most disparate
musical traditions. Of these musical traditions, those that have a prominent role in this project
are the Indian classical tradition which is a modal system bearing similarities to the Arabic and
Persian traditions, the music of the European middle ages, and to a lesser extent the sacred 2
chants of the Sufis, Byzantines and Jews, as well as the Chinese, Ancient Greek, and more recent
(meaning post-medieval) European musical traditions. The prominence of these particular
traditions is not due to them being regarded as superior in relation to others, but due to the
availability of extensive commentaries, from both traditional and modern sources, on their
theory, which allows one to consider how the principles underlying these musical traditions
should be understood in their traditional context. Moreover, it is not the intention of this project
to provide an encyclopedic account of numerous musical traditions, but rather to use
representative examples in the interest of illustrating universal principles.
Music, like language, has its origins in the earliest part of the human story. According to Nils
Lennart “It is probably safe to assume that musical instruments are at least as old as anatomically
1 Vincent Duckles & Jann Pasler, ‘The Nature of Musicology,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 17, (London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 488-492 2 Harold S. Powers, ‘India: Theory and Practice of Classical Music,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 12, (London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 178-188
7
modern humans if not much older.” This statement does not even account for musical activity 3
that does not require the use of instruments, which almost certainly predates the construction of
even the most primitive instruments. Although this music has not been preserved in written
form, it is possible that a culture like that of the Indigenous Australians, which has existed
continuously for 65,000 years, represents an example of what very ancient music may have been 4
like. Our understanding of the music of nomadic peoples, not to mention their culture in general,
necessarily remains relatively fragmentary, since such peoples leave behind less tangible
remnants of their passage through this world; this is often mistakenly regarded as a mark of
inferiority.
One of the earliest examples of a musical system developed in a sedentary culture is the classical
music of India. The Rigveda, the earliest of the Hindu scriptures which dates to the second
millennium BC, contains references to Indian classical music. This same period of history also 5
provides us with the first examples of notated music and a wide variety of musical instruments. 6
Whilst discoveries of notated music and musical instruments from the second millenium BC and
before are relatively few in number, there are more available examples from the first millennium
BC of notated music, musical instruments, and in particular, contemporary commentaries on
musical theory and practice. In these commentaries one idea which emerges, and which for
Westerners is usually associated with the Pythagorean school, is what is referred to by Alain
Danielou as the theory of ‘metaphysical correspondences’, the idea that the tangible 7
relationships between sounds corresponded to metaphysical principles which underlie existence
and that therefore the use to which these sounds are put is a matter of great import. Aside from
the examples of this concept in the Pythagorean school, which are well known, examples of this
understanding in Chinese culture are especially clear, in the Li Ji, which dates from at least the 8
3 Nils Lennart et al. (eds), The Origins of Music, (Cambridge, Massachusetts: MIT Press, 1999), p. 2 4 Chris Clarkson et al., ‘Human occupation of northern Australia by 65,000 years ago,’ Nature 547, (London: Macmillan, 2017), pp. 306-310 5 Richard Nidel, World Music: The Basics, (New York: Routledge, 2005), p. 10 6 Marie K. Stolba, The Development of Western Music: A History, (New York: McGraw Hill, 1998), p. 2 7 Alain Danielou, Music and the Power of Sound: The Influence of Tuning and the Interval on Consciousness, (Rochester: Inner Traditions, 1995, 1st edn. 1943), p. 1 8 Li Ji, trans. James Legge, https://ctext.org/liji [accessed 11 May 2018]
8
Han dynasty (206BC - 220AD) it is stated that “music is intimately connected with the essential
relations between beings”, and according to Dong Zhongzu (second century BC): 9
“The vital spirits of humankind, tuned to the tone of heaven and earth, express all the
tremors of heaven and earth, just as several cithars, all tuned on gong, all vibrate when
the note gong sounds. The fact of harmony between heaven and earth and humankind
does not come from a physical union, from a direct action; it comes from a tuning on the
same note producing vibrations in unison...In the universe nothing happens by chance,
there is no spontaneity, all is influence and harmony, accord answering accord.” 10
One could cite similar examples from classical Chinese texts in which there is a recurring theme
of a universal ‘harmony’ which governs both heaven and earth, and that common music is an
echo of this harmony. The quotation given above is notable for expressing the idea that it is in
fact ‘vibration’ which produces the correspondence between the divine and earthly realms.
A representative of the Indian tradition, Ksemaraja (10th to 11th century AD), expresses this idea
thus:
“The bindu, wanting to manifest the thought it has of all things, vibrates, and is
transformed into a primordial sound...Sound which is of the nature of nada (vibration),
resides in all living beings.” 11
In Hindu metaphysics, the bindu, or point, is the central point of unity through which all creation
comes into existence. Here Ksemaraja articulates the same idea as Dong Zhongzu, that it is by 12
means of ‘vibration’, or sound, that this creative process is brought about. Here the sound that is
spoken of is not physical sound, but that which sound, by its qualities of intangibility and
9 Danielou op. cit., p. 2 10 Ibid., p. 2 11 Ibid., p. 3 12 Jose Jacob, The Architectural Theory of Manasara, Doctoral Thesis, (Montreal: McGill University, School of Architecture, 2003), pp. 51-52
9
evocative power, corresponds to in the metaphysical domain. The bindu, is in some respects
analogous to the Logos in Hellenic and Christian metaphysics, which allows us to draw a parallel
with the most expressly metaphysical passage of the New Testament.
“In the beginning was the Word, and the Word was with God, and the Word was God.
The same was in the beginning with God.
All things were made by him; and without him was not anything made that was made.” 13
The Logos, is the central point of unity through which the creation comes into existence just as
the bindu is in Hindu metaphysics. In both Latin and English Logos is rendered as Word, thus
identifying the beginning of the creative process with an utterance, that is to say, with sound.
Fabre d’Olivet describes how these concepts were understood by Pythagoras and his school:
“Several centuries before Plato, Pythagoras, imbued with Egyptian doctrine, requested
his disciples to reject the judgment of their ears as susceptible to error and variation
where harmonic principles are concerned. He wanted them to regulate those immovable
principles only according to the proportional and analogical harmony of numbers.” 14
The idea that the mathematical relationships underlying musical sounds are connected to
universal principles, articulated in the statements above and of which Pythagoras remains the
best known Western exponent, was taken up by philosophers more concerned with social order
and morality and thus led them to the conclusion that the type of music which is prevalent in a
society in both representative of its moral condition, and more importantly actually has a causal
influence over the moral rectitude of a society. This idea is an important theme in Plato’s
Republic, as evidenced by the following passage:
13 Gospel of John 1:1-3 14 Fabre d’Olivet, Music Explained as Science and Art and considered in its analogical relations to Religious Mysteries, Ancient Mythology, and the History of the World, trans. Joscelyn Godwin, (Rochester: Inner Traditions, 1987), pp. 58-59, 1st edn. 1928
10
“...gracelessness, arrhythmia and disharmony are akin to evil speaking and evil temper,
but the opposites are the symbols and the kind of the opposites, the sober and good
disposition...the poets that we must supervise and compel to embody in their poems the
semblance of the good ethos or else not write poetry among us, or must we keep watch
over the other craftsmen, and forbid them to represent the evil disposition, the licentious,
the illiberal, the graceless, either in the likeness of living creatures or in buildings or in
any other products of their art...that our guardians may not be bred among symbols of
evil, as it were in a pasturage of poisonous herbs, lest grazing freely (they) build up a
huge mass of evil in their own souls.” 15
Plato’s suggestion that music can influence the moral character of both the individual and the
wider society is mirrored in the Chinese tradition, where the relationship between metaphysics
and the moral character of society is a recurring theme. This is clear in the following passage
from the Yue Ji:
“In periods of disorder, rites are altered and music is licentious. Then sad sounds are
lacking in dignity, joyful sounds lacking in calmness...When the spirit of opposition
manifests itself, indecent music comes into being...when the spirit of conformity
manifests itself, harmonious music appears.” 16
The preceding passages, taken from a variety of traditions, demonstrate a consistent
understanding among the ancients that musical sounds have a significance that goes beyond their
immediately tangible effects and are related to metaphysical principles that can also be expressed
numerically through the ratios that govern musical intervals. This gave rise, in the civilisations
in question, to musical systems that organise these intervals into modes and scales, in which the
significance of each interval is given its full due since it can be clearly discerned in relation to a
relatively static tonic note. Rhythmic organisation was governed by similar rules, such as the
15 Plato, The Republic in Strunk/Treitler, Source Readings in Music History, (New York: W.W. Norton and Company Inc., 1951), p. 14 16 Yue Ji 29-30, https://ctext.org/liji/yue-ji [accessed 14 May 2018]
11
system of Talas in Indian music, a type of rhythmic cycle more complex than the simple meters
of European classical music, in which beats are arranged hierarchically in complex patterns. 17
The common thread which connects the examples given thus far relates not only to music, but to
a way of thinking that was shared by all traditional civilisations. In this way of thinking, the
metaphysical Absolute expressed as an anthropomorphic God in theistic religions or Brahman in
the Hindu religion, and not man, was at the centre of the universal hierarchy. The traditional 18
sciences consisted of applications of metaphysical principles to various domains and their 19
primary concern was not material progress, but a reintegration of the human soul through
external objects taken as symbols. The Renaissance, which took place in Europe beginning in
the 15th century, marks a development away from this understanding towards a point of view
centered on man, in which science consists primarily of experimentation in the material domain
in order to seek results which in turn produce material progress. This was largely a result of the,
not entirely unjustified, undermining of the authority of the Catholic Church. This material 20 21
progress in turn is used to justify the notion of the superiority of modern civilisation, which
originated in Europe and which has now become global, absorbing and largely replacing
traditional cultures.
The development of Western music to some extent runs parallel to the progress of Western 22
civilisation from the Renaissance down to our times, although these parallels are sometimes
exaggerated and do not always account for subtleties, they are nonetheless instructive. The most
significant development in the history of Western music, and this it not a qualitative evaluation
17 Powers op. cit., pp. 195-201 18 It is beyond the scope of this essay to examine the ways in which the universal hierarchy was expressed in these and other civilisations. 19 Rene Guenon, The Crisis of the Modern World, (New York: Sophia Perennis, 2004, 1st edn. 1946), p. 45 20 That is to say the many of the critiques of the Church at this time came about as a result of genuine errors on the part of the Catholic authorities, which is not to say that the resultant consequences were desirable. 21 Os Guinness, The Dust of Death: A Critique of the Establishment and the Counter Culture and the Proposal for a Third Way, (Downer’s Grove: Intervarsity Press, 1973), p. 5 22 This term is to be understood in the sense that it is used by Rene Guenon, that is to say it refers to those civilisations and attitudes which are opposed to the traditional worldview. Thus the dichotomy of East and West symbolises the opposition between tradition and modernity, despite the fact that this opposition is not restricted to particular geographical locations. These terms also have a symbolic meaning relating to the fact that the Sun rises in the East and sets in the West.
12
but rather a statement of its far reaching effects, was the development of temperament, which
concluded with equal temperament, a way of slightly altering the 12 chromatic notes produced
by the cycle of fifths in order to make them fit into an octave divided equally into 12 semitones. 23
This allowed Western music to develop systems of tonality and pitch organisation that are
completely alien to any other musical tradition in history, and eventually allowed a total
subversion of the musical substance altogether in the form of modernism. The system of equal 24
temperament expresses a reductive human tendency to rationalise the inherent complexity of a
natural system like that of the cycle of 5ths.
“The development of twelve fifths, instead of bringing us back precisely to the octave,
leaves a difference - the comma - with which we shall have to negotiate. This will
complicate every calculation and prevent us from formulating those rigid and simple
laws, attractive but inaccurate, in which our vain reason delights. This comma, which the
modern world tries so hard to ignore, represents, for those who can understand it, the
essential difference between what is finite and what is infinite. The fifths form a spiral
whose sounds, coiled around themselves, can never meet. For us, this limitless spiral can
be the joint in the structure of the world, the narrow gate that will allow us to escape from
the appearance of a closed universe...only by respecting such subtle differences can the
edifice of sounds become the image of reality and one of the ways of spiritual
realisation...this is possible precisely because, as Plotinus expresses it, this music is ‘a
terrestrial representation of the music that exists in the kingdom of the ideal world.’” 25
23 Mark Lindley, ‘Equal Temperament,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 8, (London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 275-276 24 “Equal temperament has had a strange effect on some of the musicians of the present generation. As they have never heard a consonant chord, they know chords only as more or less acute dissonances, and the rules of the old masters, who base everything around consonant chords, seem to them the effect of timidity and ignorance.” Danielou op. Cit., p. 133; “Ultramodern music - “electronic music” for example - is founded on a despising of everything that enters into the very definition of music...There is no possible justification for this puerile mania for “making a clean sweep” of centuries or millennia in order to “start from scratch”, coupled with the inventing of new principles, new bases, new structures - such invention is not merely senseless in itself but also incompatible with any creative sincerity.” Frithjof Schuon, Language of the Self, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 1999), p. 108 25 Danielou op. cit., p. 7
13
Thus it is only by the acknowledgement of the underlying mathematical structures of sound,
which are not easily reducible to a straightforward and rational system such as that of equal
temperament, that music can ascend to become a “terrestrial representation of the music that
exists in the kingdom of the ideal world.” The additional harmonic possibilities afforded by
equal temperament cannot replace the loss of the evocative power of precisely tuned intervals.
The development of Western music in the aftermath of equal temperament was, unsurprisingly,
characterised by a relatively rapid evolution of styles and techniques, given the wealth of
possibilities created by this system. The emergence of rationalist and humanist tendencies in 26
musical expression are particularly evident in the development of the Classical style which
occurred during the period of the Enlightenment. The emergence of sonata form as the
preeminent form of musical composition reflected an increasingly rationalist approach to musical
composition in keeping with Enlightenment ideals, at the same time it ensured that secular
instrumental music obtained the highest place of honour in the Western musical tradition. In the 27
nineteenth century, romanticism reacted against the rationalist simplifications of the classical
period, but rather than being music centred on metaphysical principles it was increasingly music
centred upon man, but man in his emotive and sentimental aspect, rather than as a rational
being. Finally the birth of modernism in the 20th century, and particularly in the period 28
immediately following the second world war, sought to break with the tradition of classical
music, itself only a relatively recent phenomenon. Interestingly, one of the key concepts of 29
early modernism, the 12-tone system, would have been inconceivable without the system of
equal temperament, itself a relic of the baroque era. Modernist music represents the antithesis of
the traditional understanding of music, here the musical substance is simply a plaything to be
26 To consider this as a mark of the superiority of this system is to reveal a perspective that evaluates the matter on purely quantitative considerations. 27 James Webster, ‘Sonata Form,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 23, (London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 687-701 28 By these criticisms it is not the intention to suggest that Western classical music of this era is devoid of value, but to draw attention to certain tendencies which must, from a traditionalist perspective, be considered erroneous. Those who wish to criticise musical modernism and do so based on the premise that it subverted the Western classical tradition which reached its highest point of late romanticism are mistaken in not recognising the roots of the modernist tendency in romanticism itself, not merely from a technical standpoint, but in terms of spiritual content. 29 Pierre Boulez, ‘Where are we now?’ in Orientations, ed. Jean-Jaques Nattiez, (London: Faber 1986), p. 445, transcript of a lecture entitled ‘Où En Est-On?’ given in May 1968.
14
manipulated by the composer for any purpose they decide and thus becomes ‘art for art’s sake’.
The idea that music has a function that goes beyond itself is no longer a consideration.
The effect of modernist music, with its abandonment of tradition, albeit a relatively fragmentary
and recent tradition in the form of classical music, was deeply alienating, given that practical
result of this approach meant that music essentially lost its capacity to communicate expressive
content, having been initially severely diminished as a result of equal temperament. The 30 31
reactions to this realisation, taking place in an intellectual environment which no longer had any
unifying principles, produced innumerably varied results. Many of these reactions, in one way
or another have taken the form of a return to tradition, although usually only in a fragmentary
manner. For many such as the so called ‘holy minimalists’, Henryk Górecki, Arvo Pärt, and 32
John Tavener, this has meant reconnecting with the Christian tradition, both in religious terms
and musically. Others have looked to the East, such as Terry Riley who mastered Indian
classical vocal music. The extent to which it is possible to successfully reintegrate oneself into 33
a tradition after the break created by developments in the West since the Renaissance and
particularly in the 20th century is a point for further consideration and one which is at the heart
of this project.
Music has played a central role in most cultures throughout human history, and the global
super-culture of the 21st century is no exception. However, as our culture has become
modernised it has shaped music and the other arts into forms which match its outlook and its
values, and which are rejected by those who identify, in one way or another, as traditionalists.
The following project is an attempt to explore how traditional aesthetic and artistic values might
be rediscovered in the composition of new musical works, in particular by adopting the
30 Music had already been reduced to the evocation of emotional states, but this final development essentially made modern music unintelligible to the listener, and particularly to those who were not initiated into the cult surrounding this artform at the time. 31 It is both a practical fact, and a point of considerable significance, that modernist music could not have been conceived of without the development of equal temperament centuries earlier. 32 Keith Potter, ‘Minimalism,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 16, (London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 716-718 33 Edward Strickland, ‘Riley, Terry,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 21, (London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 395-396
15
metaphysical and aesthetic perspective of the Traditionalist School, which was a school of
thought associated with 20th century writers such as Réné Guénon, Ananda Coomaraswamy and
Frithjof Schuon. 34
This project therefore, consists of an introduction to the history and the central ideas of the
Traditionalist School, followed by an examination of their contributions to aesthetics and the
philosophy of art. Such an overview is necessary to contextualise the remainder of the project,
given that much of this material is relatively unknown in academic circles. It is also important to
note that the traditionalists are essentially attempting to discern a common thread that runs
throughout all religious, philosophical and artistic traditions prior to the modern era, and in 35
accordance with this idea this project seeks to utilise these underlying concepts that are found in
various traditions. The particular focus on the work of the traditionalists of the 20th century is
solely due to the fact that it is in these works that these concepts are elucidated in a way that is
particularly clear to the modern reader and dispels many errors that modern readers may make in
approaching traditional sources. Finally, this project discusses the various issues associated with
the application of these concepts to the composition of new works, and includes an analysis of
works composed throughout the duration of the masters candidature to determine their success in
making use of these concepts.
The primary aim of this creative compositional project, at the M.Phil. level, is to produce a body
of new work informed by the ideas of the Traditionalist School. In order to achieve this aim it
has been necessary to define precisely how the literature in question informs the compositional
process. This has involved reviewing the body of traditionalist literature that is relevant to the
topic, both directly and indirectly, and deriving from this a set of aesthetic and technical
principles that inform the creative process. This project has been conducted primarily through
the composition of new works and secondarily through a discussion of creative methods and
theoretical principles derived from traditionalist ideas.
34 Renaud Fabbri, ‘Introduction to the Perennialist School,’ Religio Perennis, http://religioperennis.org/documents/Fabbri/Perennialism.pdf [accessed 14 May 2018] 35 James Cutsinger, ‘Christianity and the Perennial Philosophy,’ Religio Perennis, http://religioperennis.org/documents/cutsinger/Christ_Perennial.pdf [accessed 28/01/2018]
16
It is not the intention of this project to present a complete explanation or justification of the
philosophical principles in question. These are presented purely insofar as they form the basis of
aesthetic decisions and therefore they function as a premise rather than as an object of the
research. In other words the philosophical positions espoused by the traditionalists but which are
by no means unique to them form the basis of a project which is primarily compositional and
merely takes these positions as a source of creative inspiration. 36
According to the authors of the traditionalist school, the purpose of art is to act as a vehicle for
metaphysical principles. Taking this position as a starting point, the creative project has been
guided and interrogated by the following key research questions:
1. What are the principles of traditional art that are manifested in the aesthetic, theoretical
and methodological aspects of traditional musical systems?
2. How can these principles be applied to the conception and composition of music?
3. How can these ideas be realised effectively in the performance of new works and what
are the potential obstacles to this realisation?
The first research question is addressed in this project through a thorough review of the relevant
literature and an attempt to derive from this a clear set of principles and aesthetic preferences.
The second question is primarily addressed through the works themselves and secondarily
through the theoretical considerations that preceded their composition, as well as the subsequent
analysis. The third question is again addressed through the works, although less satisfactorily
given that relatively few of the works have as yet received performances in their final forms.
However, the primary obstacles that could be identified by this question, which are related to
36 This point is also relevant in order to forestall a possible objection to the compositions included in the project. The fact that the aesthetic decisions were governed by the aesthetic philosophy of the traditionalist school led me to adopt a musical language which eschewed complexity and works of a large scale, both in terms of duration and instrumental forces. This approach seemed in some sense to be at odds with the aim of composing works for a postgraduate portfolio, but was necessary in order to remain consistent with the principles outlined in the following chapters.
17
tuning, were identified prior to the works being completed and, in the opinion of the composer,
largely avoided. This would however be a point for further exploration in the future.
Chapter 1: History and Ideas of the Traditionalist School
The History of the Traditionalist School
The history of the traditionalist school as a 20th century intellectual movement, though not of its
ideas which are derived from traditional sources, begins with Réné Guénon, who was effectively
the founder of the school. Born in France in 1886, he had a Catholic upbringing and moved to
Paris as a young man to study mathematics. During the first decade of the 20th century, 37
Guénon was linked to a number of spiritualist and occultist groups who were prevalent in Paris at
the time, but by the end of this decade he had rejected their ideas in favour of the sapiential
esoterisms of orthodox spiritual traditions and later wrote critiques of both Theosophism and 38
spiritism. It was also during this time that Guenon came into contact with a group of Hindus of
the Advaita Vedanta school, which became central to his metaphysical philosophy. 39
Although Guénon had been initiated into a Sufi society in 1912, his first book was an exposition
of metaphysics as it is manifested in the Hindu tradition. According to Martin Lings, he chose 40
this subject because he believed that his intended audience, the European intelligentsia, was
more likely to be responsive to traditional doctrines as they appear in this form, and not because
of any innate superiority. This work, originally titled General Introduction to the Study of Hindu
Doctrines, was rejected as a doctoral thesis which effectively ended Guénon’s commitment to 41
37 Harry Oldmeadow, ‘Réné Guénon’s Life and Work,’ adapted from: Journeys East: 20th Century Western Encounters with Eastern Religious Traditions, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2004), http://www.worldwisdom.com/public/authors/Rene-Guenon.aspx [accessed 28/01/2018] 38 The term ‘esoterism’, rather than ‘esotericism’, is the one preferred by traditionalist authors. 39 Ibid. 40 Martin Lings, introduction to The Essential Réné Guénon, Réné Guénon, ed. John Herlihy (Bloomington: World Wisdom, 2009), p. xvii 41 Réné Guénon, Introduction to the Study of Hindu Doctrines, trans. Marco Pallis, (London: Luzac & co., 1945)
18
academia. Guénon’s best known book, The Crisis of the Modern World, which summarises the 42
traditionalist rejection of modernity as a phenomenon and as an ideology was published in 1927.
In 1930, Guenon travelled to Egypt as part of a project for the study and publication of Sufi texts.
He never left Egypt and eventually died there in 1951, having remained reclusive for the last
twenty years of his life.
The traditionalist school is usually regarded as having two additional founding members aside
from Guenon. These are Ananda Coomaraswamy and Frithjof Schuon. Coomaraswamy, born in
Ceylon in 1877, was an influential art historian and curator working at the Boston Museum of
Fine Arts. Coomaraswamy was influenced by the writings of Guénon during the 1920s after 43
being introduced to them by fellow art historian, Heinrich Zimmer. In speaking of Guénon,
Coomaraswamy stated that “no living writer in modern Europe is more significant than René
Guénon, whose task it has been to expound the universal metaphysical tradition that has been the
essential foundation of every past culture, and which represents the indispensable basis for any
civilization deserving to be so-called” and also that he and Guénon were “entirely in agreement 44
on metaphysical principles.” Coomaraswamy wrote extensively on topics related to the 45
application of traditionalist ideas in the arts, and by comparison with Guenon was well known
outside of the immediate circle of the traditionalist school.
Of the three founding members of the traditionalist school, the most significant in terms of their
direct, personal influence, as opposed to the influence of the ideas found in their writings, is
undoubtedly Frithjof Schuon. Schuon was born in Switzerland in 1907. As a young man he 46
studied the various traditional doctrines, in particular the Indian scriptures such as the
Upanishads and the Bhagavad-Gita. He also came into contact with the work of Réné Guénon
42 Réné Guénon, The Crisis of the Modern World, trans. Marco Pallis, Arthur Osbourne, Richard C. Nicholson, (Hillsdale, New York: Sophia Perennis, 2001), originally published 1946 43 Harry Oldmeadow, ‘Ananda Coomaraswamy’s Life and Work,’ adapted from: Journeys East: 20th Century Western Encounters with Eastern Religious Traditions, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2004), http://www.worldwisdom.com/public/authors/Ananda-K-Coomaraswamy.aspx [accessed 28/01/2018] 44 Ibid. 45 Ibid. 46 Mark Perry, ‘Ananda Coomaraswamy’s Life and Work,’ adapted from Frithjof Schuon: Metaphysician and Artist, previously unpublished, http://www.worldwisdom.com/public/authors/Frithjof-Schuon.aspx [accessed 28/01/2018]
19
whose influence was decisive in his intellectual formation. During an obligatory posting with
the French army he met with a group of Yemeni dervishes (a member of a Sufi order who has
taken vows of poverty) which resulted in him travelling to North Africa where he was initiated
into the Shadhili Sufi order by Shaykh Ahmad al-Alawi. One significant result of this encounter
being that Schuon was invested with the right to initiate his own disciples. Through his own
branch of the Shadhili order, known as the Maryamiyya, Schuon is known to have initiated
several disciples who themselves became significant contributors to the traditionalist school.
Among these are Martin Lings, Titus Burckhardt, and Seyyed Hossein Nasr, with the latter
being, at the time of writing, probably the most significant living proponent of the traditionalist
school. The school of Frithjof Schuon represents the mature flourishing of the ideas that were
introduced by Guenon. Of the three aforementioned disciples, Titus Burckhardt is of the greatest
significance for the purpose of this study, given that much of his work focuses on the topic of
sacred art and the application of traditionalist principles to the domain of aesthetics.
The influence of the traditionalist school in Western academia has remained limited due to their
condemnation of its intellectual premises and their assertion of the superiority of traditional
doctrines, a thesis that has never been widely accepted in Western academic circles. On the
other hand, the traditionalists have had a considerable influence on the intellectual life of the
Islamic world in the 20th and 21st centuries, due to the fact that this is the tradition with which
many of the members of the school were and are affiliated. Of the aforementioned disciples of 47
Frithjof Schuon, Martin Lings authored perhaps the best known biography of the prophet
Muhammad صلى الله عليه وسلم in the English language, and Seyyed Hossein Nasr is widely recognised as a 48
significant scholar whose contributions include numerous books on Islamic philosophy and
mysticism, as well as a recent English edition of the Quran which brings together multiple
traditional commentaries. 49
47 I include myself in this statement, having ‘reverted’ (this term is preferred to ‘converted’) to Islam approximately six months before the commencement of this project. 48 Martin Lings, Muhammad: His Life Based on the Earliest Sources, (Rochester: Inner Traditions, 2006), 1st edn. 1986 49 Seyyed Hossein Nasr (editor), The Study Quran, (New York: Harper Collins, 2015)
20
In Western academia, the traditionalist school was perhaps most influential within the sphere of
comparative religion, which is unsurprising given that this subject forms the bulk of the work of
Schuon and his disciples. It is also within this discipline that it has received its greatest share of
criticism. Generally speaking the criticism of the traditionalist school comes from two main
perspectives. On the one hand, those who are committed to a particular religious perspective
tend to criticize it on the basis that it does not affirm the truth of a single religious form to the
exclusion of others, on the other most academics tend to see these concepts as
pseudo-intellectual, with little or no objective foundation. From this latter perspective, the
traditionalist thesis that there is an underlying common thread between the various traditions of
humanity seems simplistic and reductive, and their assertions seem to be made in the absence of
sufficient evidence. A third criticism that is sometimes made of the traditionalist school comes
from a more political perspective, and this is a criticism from some left wing intellectuals that the
traditionalist school has an association with fascism and the far-right. This is due to the
connection between Réné Guénon, and Italian author Julius Evola, who took some traditionalist
ideas and combined them with contemporary fascism. Evola’s subsequent influence on far-right
politics is well documented however he has never been regarded as a genuine traditionalist by
those who subscribe to the philosophy as articulated by Guénon, Schuon and Coomaraswamy. 50
It is beyond the scope of this introductory background to address any of these criticisms, and
they are provided here merely to contextualise the school within the wider academic community.
The Ideas of the Traditionalist School
The central thesis of the traditionalist school is what is known as the perennial philosophy.
Alternative terminologies sometimes employed are the latin philosophia perennis, or simply
sophia perennis, and also in the writings of Schuon, religio perennis. The perennial philosophy 51
is an underlying truth hidden beneath the veils of form in various religious and philosophical
traditions. The content of this perennial philosophy is essentially metaphysical, and refers to the
50 Fabbri op. cit. 51 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Religio Perennis,’ Religio Perennis, http://religioperennis.org/documents/Schuon/religioperennis.pdf [accessed 20/01/2018]
21
knowledge of the non-dualistic, non-contingent nature of absolute Reality and the illusory nature
of human subjectivity and contingent realities. In the following passage Frithjof Schuon gives 52
an introduction to the traditionalist understanding of the perennial philosophy and outlines some
of the ways in which it contrasts with contemporary philosophy:
“‘Philosophia perennis’ is generally understood as referring to that metaphysical truth
which has no beginning, and which remains the same in all expressions of wisdom.
Perhaps it would here be better or more prudent to speak of a “Sophia perennis”, since it
is not a question of artificial mental constructions, as is all too often the case in
philosophy; or again, the primordial wisdom that always remains true to itself could be
called “religio perennis”, given that by its nature it in a sense involves worship and
spiritual realization. Fundamentally we have nothing against the word “philosophy”, for
the ancients understood by it all manner of wisdom; in fact, however, rationalism, which
has absolutely nothing to do with true spiritual contemplation, has given the word
“philosophy” a limitative colouring, so that with this word one can never know what is
really being referred to. If Kant is a “philosopher”, then Plotinus is not, and vice versa.
With Sophia perennis, it is a question of the following: there are truths innate in the
human Spirit, which nevertheless in a sense lie buried in the depth of the “Heart” — in
the pure Intellect — and are accessible only to the one who is spiritually contemplative;
and these are the fundamental metaphysical truths. Access to them is possessed by the
“gnostic”, “pneumatic” or “theosopher” — in the original and not the sectarian meaning
of these terms — and access to them was also possessed by the “philosophers” in the real
and still innocent sense of the word: for example, Pythagoras, Plato and to a large extent
also Aristotle.
52 Ibid.
22
The fundamental content of the Truth is the Unconditioned, the Metaphysical Absolute;
the Ultimate One, which is also the Absolutely Good, the Platonic Agathon.” 53
The last sentence of this statement addresses the question of what the actual content of this
knowledge is. A particularly clear statement of this content occurs in the philosophy of Adi
Shankara, founder of the Advaita Vedanta school of Hindu philosophy, which states that Reality
(Brahman), is a single unchanging entity, and the appearance of change is an illusion created by
the spatio-temporal, and psychological, limitations of human subjectivity. This philosophy is 54
also clearly articulated in Sufi metaphysics and is perhaps best summarised by Ibn Ata’illah in
the following statement:
“God did not veil Himself from thee by some reality coexisting with Him, since there is
no reality other than He. What veils Him from thee is naught but the illusion that
something outside Him could possess any reality.” 55
All further investigations and concepts in traditionalist literature proceed from this premise. That
absolute Reality alone is real and the appearance of changing entities is essentially a kind of
illusion. The ‘realisation’ of this knowledge, such that one’s perception is fundamentally altered
in such a way as to be permanently fixed on the unchanging Reality is considered to be the
ultimate goal of all religious and spiritual traditions. It is for this reason that this is not simply an
intellectual theory, but requires an element of spiritual praxis in order for these truths to be
realised by the individual.
The traditionalist understanding of cosmology is essentially that the universe is on the one hand a
kind of illusion caused by the limitations of our subjectivity, and on the other hand the domain in
53 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Sophia Perennis’ in The Essential Frithjof Schuon, trans. William Stoddart, edited by Seyyed Hossein Nasr (Bloomington: World Wisdom, 2005), p. 534 54 Dakshinâmnâya Sri Sharada Peetham, ‘Sri Adi Shankaracharya,’ http://www.sringeri.net/history/sri-adi-shankaracharya [accessed 29/01/2018] 55 Titus Burckhardt, The Essential Titus Burckhardt, edited by William Stoddart, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 2003), p. 273
23
which the limitless possibility inherent in absolute Reality is manifest. This occurs through a
process of “metaphysical descent,” whereby the qualities inherent in the One are at a more
relative degree of existence differentiated into archetypal principles. At a degree of reality that is
more relative and more outward still, this process culminates in the manifestation of qualities
through particular and contingent instantiations in the universe, without these relative degrees of
reality ever actually departing from the absolute non-duality of the Real except in an illusory
manner. This cosmological conception is present in the monotheistic traditions as the idea of 56
theophany, or the self-disclosure of God, in Hinduism as the doctrine of Maya, and also in 57
Platonist philosophical traditions as the idea of emanation. This cosmological conception is of
particular significance for the purposes of this study, since it is this understanding of the nature
of the universe that informs the traditionalist understanding of aesthetics and the purpose of art.
Having mentioned the way in which traditionalist cosmology draws upon numerous traditions
both religious and philosophical, it is necessary to examine the way in which traditionalists
understand the role of tradition, as it is of central importance both to the doctrine. The
traditionalists recognise the possibility of metaphysical truths being articulated by philosophy
and they generally recognise the Platonists as an example of this. However, religion is 58
considered to be a more significant phenomenon for a number of reasons. Firstly it proceeds
from revelation, a point in time in which the Real manifests itself directly within the framework
of a particular human society. This phenomenon establishes a particular mythological 59
framework through which Reality is to be addressed, and which itself is addressed to all people,
not merely those with an aptitude for philosophy. This latter point means that a religion 60
necessarily has multiple levels at which it can be interpreted, depending upon the nature of the
one to whom it is addressing itself. At the highest levels of esoteric interpretation, most of the
major world religions are regarded by the traditionalists as converging upon the same essential
56 Frithjof Schuon, Survey of Metaphysics and Esoterism, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 2000), p. 17 57 Ibid., p. 47 58 Frithjof Schuon, ‘The Dialogue Between Hellenists and Christians’ in The Fullness of God, edited by James Cutsinger, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2004), p. 61 59 Seyyed Hossein Nasr, Knowledge and the Sacred (New York: SUNY press, 1989), 67 60 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Frithjof Schuon-extended interview on metaphysics,religion and poetry,’ https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=F9T90GWfk40 [accessed 29/01/2018]
24
metaphysical truths, without this ever abolishing their differentiation at the level of form. This
theory was named in the title of Frithjof Schuon’s first book, The Transcendent Unity of
Religions. 61
One final point that must be made in introducing the key ideas of the traditionalist school relates
to their understanding of the nature of history. In contrast to the progressive ideals that were in
vogue at the time when Réné Guénon began writing, he regarded history as a story of continuous
decline, culminating in the modern era which represents the most decadent and spiritually poor
society that humanity has yet produced. The traditionalists see the immense material progress 62
of modernity as confirming this thesis, insofar as it represents a humanity that has turned all its
attention to concerns related to matter and the outward and has no regard for the development of
the inward faculties of man. Guénon was particularly influenced by the Hindu doctrine of the 63
four Yugas, or ages, which states that history passes through great cycles known as manvantaras.
These cycles consist of four Yugas, the first age being the most spiritually elevated and the final
age, the Kali Yuga or dark age, being the most spiritually deprived. Guenon’s best known 64
book, The Crisis of the Modern World , is an examination of the way in which modernity 65
corresponds to the final phase of the Kali Yuga. It is notable that this doctrine is not confined to
Hinduism, but similar doctrines are common in ancient literature, and virtually all traditions view
history as both cyclical and subject to entropy rather than progress.
The Traditionalist Doctrine of Art
The traditionalist doctrine of art draws upon the cosmological conception outlined above. This
can be summarised as the idea that the qualities inherent in ultimate Reality are, at a more
relative level of existence, differentiated into archetypes which at a still more relative level of
61 Frithjof Schuon, The Transcendent Unity of Religions (Wheaton: Quest Books, 1993, 1st. Edn., 1953) 62 Rene Guenon, The Crisis of the Modern World, trans. Marco Pallis, Arthur Osbourne, Richard C. Nicholson, (Hillsdale, New York: Sophia Perennis, 2001), p. 2 63 Ibid., p. 81 64 Ibid., p. 7 65 Ibid.
25
existence, that of the manifest universe, are differentiated further into distinct objects. The arts
then, are the sciences of perceiving archetypal qualities in forms, and distilling those forms in
such a way as to retrace those qualities. Their essential function is to create an ambience that is 66
conducive to contemplation and to returning to consciousness of the Real. This ambience is 67
nearly ubiquitous in the natural world, but in the case of human civilisation, the artistic sciences
are necessary to create an ambience that is conducive to sanctity. The traditionalist 68
understanding is that art has functioned in this way in all traditional civilisations, with the
notable exceptions of post-Renaissance Europe and the Classical Greek and Roman
civilisations. One possible objection to this idea is that if every form has as its source ultimate 69
Reality, then why is it necessary to distinguish certain forms as having particular merit in the
arts? The traditionalist response to this once again draws upon a concept that is articulated by
Hindu philosophy. This is the idea that within the domain of relativity, there are three
metaphysical ‘directions’, these are Sattva (upwards, towards Oneness), rajas (expansive,
remaining on the same plane of relativity), and tamas (downwards, drawing one further into
multiplicity and away from unity). Certain forms correspond to a greater or lesser degree to
these directions, in other words, certain forms directly realise archetypal qualities within
particular existential limitations, and therefore are directed upwards, whereas others are
distinguished their opposition of form to essence and tend downwards, remaining within
multiplicity. It is the traditionalist understanding that the aesthetic of modern urban societies are
essentially ‘tamasic’. 70
As stated above, the traditionalists regard the arts as being governed by traditional ‘sciences’,
which do not correspond to the sciences of the modern world but rather are applications of
66 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Concerning Forms in Art’ in The Transcendent Unity of Religions, (Wheaton: Quest Books 1993), p. 61 67 Ibid., p. 65 68 Ibid. 69 Titus Burckhardt, ‘The Universality of Sacred Art’ in The Essential Titus Burckhardt, edited by William Stoddart, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2003), p. 87 70 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Foundations of an Integral Aesthetics’ in The Essential Frithjof Schuon, trans. William Stoddart, edited by Seyyed Hossein Nasr, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2005), p. 379
26
metaphysical principles to particular domains. The foundational science that governs the arts is 71
the science of the correspondence between a form and its archetype or essence. This is what is 72
known as symbolism. It is important to note that, according to this definition, a symbol is not
merely a convention but a ‘manifestation’ of a higher level of reality within a more relative one.
In other words, the relationship between a symbol and what it conveys is an objective reality and
not simply a subjectively defined relationship. This is articulated by Titus Burckhardt thus:
“Every form “vehicles” a particular quality of being....there is a rigorous analogy between
form and spirit. A spiritual vision necessarily finds its expression in a particular formal
language. If this language has been forgotten—with the result that a so called sacred art
draws its forms from absolutely any kind of profane art—it means that a spiritual vision
of things no longer exists.” 73
These sciences can vary according to the civilisation in question without difference in essential
principles.
“Sensible forms therefore correspond with exactness to intellections, and it is for this
reason that traditional art has rules that apply the cosmic laws and universal principles to
the domain of forms, and that, beneath their more general outward aspect, reveal the style
of the civilisation under consideration, this style, in its turn, rendering explicit the form of
intellectuality of that civilisation. When art ceases to be traditional and becomes arbitrary,
that is infallibly the sign - and secondarily the cause - of an intellectual decline…” 74
71 Rene Guenon, The Crisis of the Modern World, trans. Marco Pallis, Arthur Osbourne, Richard C. Nicholson, (Hillsdale, New York: Sophia Perennis, 2001), p. 42 72 Ananda Coomaraswamy, ‘Ars Sine Scientia Nihil’ in The Essential Ananda Coomaraswamy, edited by Rama Coomaraswamy, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2004), p. 177 73 Titus Burckhardt, ‘The Universality of Sacred Art’ in The Essential Titus Burckhardt, edited by William Stoddart (Bloomington: World Wisdom 2003), p. 87 74 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Concerning Forms in Art’ in The Transcendent Unity of Religions, (Wheaton: Quest Books 1993), p. 62
27
The traditionalists are draw a sharp distinction between civilisations in which art is conceived in
this manner, and the modern world in which aesthetic choices are regarded as arbitrary. This is
not considered by the traditionalists to be a matter that is inconsequential, but rather as Schuon
states, it is both a sign, and a cause of intellectual and spiritual decadence.
Another way in which the traditionalists distinguish the arts of traditional societies and those of
the modern world, is that an art was traditionally regarded both as a vocation and a craft.
Ananda Coomaraswamy points out that for traditional societies, the distinction between art and
craft did not really exist, whereas in modern post-industrial societies, the element of art has been
removed from the crafts, which have been replaced by mass-production whose products are
inhuman and ugly, and the element of craft has been removed from art, which has turned in on
itself to such an extent that it no longer maintains any significant connection to the lives of the
majority of people. The modern artist essentially manipulates their chosen medium in an 75
entirely subjective manner in accordance with whatever desire or passions happen to motivate
them. The traditional artist on the other hand, submits firstly to the traditional rules of the craft,
which transmit something of the science of symbolism related to that particular medium. In 76
addition to this, the traditional artist engages in an inward discipline, attempting to attain
contemplative states in which the qualities of the forms that they intend to convey are realised
within their own soul.
“True form is thus neither limitable nor mutable; it is like a ray of the creative Spirit
which, descending into matter, fleetingly lends it form. An analogy for this is artistic
creation: just as the artist may more or less completely...imprint on a material the spiritual
picture that he carries within himself, so the essence of a thing may manifest itself more
or less perfectly in that particular thing.” 77
75 Ananda Coomaraswamy, ‘The Christian and Oriental, or True, Philosophy of Art’ in The Essential Ananda Coomaraswamy, edited by Rama Coomaraswamy, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2004), p. 123 76 Ibid., p. 131 77 Titus Burckhardt, ‘Christian Art’ in The Essential Titus Burckhardt, edited by William Stoddart (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2003), p. 131
28
Chapter 2: Application of the Ideas of the Traditionalist
School to Musical Composition
Application of Traditionalist Doctrine to Musical Composition: Part 1 - Schuon’s
‘Principles and Criteria’
The question of how the traditionalist doctrines relating to art would be applied in the context of
musical composition, and specifically in this project, requires an approach that encompasses both
aesthetic philosophy, artistic method, and technical considerations. In the context of this project,
the first two of these are of primary significance. The reason for this is that it is not the intention
of this project to develop a closed theoretical system based on the principles outlined in the
previous chapters, but rather to compose new works which are influenced by these principles.
As such, the development of specific techniques will remain a secondary consideration, although
certain theoretical principles will naturally arise in the compositional process. With these
considerations in mind, the remainder of this chapter will outline the aesthetic philosophy of the
traditionalist school, in particular the mature form of this philosophy found in the works of
Frithjof Schuon and Titus Burckhardt. It will also briefly address the question of the working
method of the artist as described by Schuon, Burckhardt and Ananda Coomaraswamy.
The most comprehensive statement of Schuon’s aesthetic philosophy is found in his essay 78
‘Principles and Criteria of Art’. Schuon begins this summation of his position on aesthetics by 79
establishing the following categorisation:
“Human art, like Divine Art, comprises both determinate and indeterminate aspects,
aspects of necessity and of freedom, of rigor and of joy.” 80
78 One may regard this as a comprehensive statement of the traditionalist school in general since Schuon represents the most precise expression of the principles of the movement. 79 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Principles and Criteria of Art’ in Language of the Self, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 1999), p. 79 80 Ibid., p. 79
29
The significance of this statement, and in particular the fact that Schuon makes it the first
principle in his summation of his aesthetic philosophy, is that it establishes that one cannot
reduce art to something that is produced through a completely rationalised system, but that it also
contains indeterminate aspects. This is of central importance in a project such as this one since it
immediately precludes the idea of producing a closed theoretical system and producing works in
accordance with this system. This statement is therefore the foundation of the folio itself which
includes varied theoretical approaches and ideas without the works contained therein being
composed in a systematic manner.
Schuon then applies this initial principle in the following way:
“This cosmic polarity enables us to establish a primary distinction, namely the distinction
between sacred and profane art: in sacred art what takes precedence over everything else
is the content and use of the work; whereas in profane art these are but a pretext for the
joys of creation.” 81
So in sacred art, defined by Schuon as traditional art which has a specifically sacred subject, the
emphasis is on rigor and precision of symbolism, whereas in profane art, traditional art which
does not have a specifically sacred subject, the emphasis is on the element of indeterminism and
creative freedom. It is important to note that in the latter case this does not preclude a strict
formal discipline which Schuon clarifies by saying:
“...such art is thus profane through the absence of a sacred subject or a spiritual
symbolism but traditional through the formal discipline that governs its style.” 82
The formal discipline in question is ensured by the traditional models and systems with which
the artist works. Schuon emphasises this point by saying that traditional art does not actually
pursue beauty as a direct objective, but rather that beauty is guaranteed by tradition and the
81 Ibid., p. 79 82 Ibid., p. 80
30
actual objective of the artist is either to directly communicate a spiritual truth, in the case of
sacred art, or to express creative freedom in the case of profane, though still traditional, art. 83
The considerations detailed up to this point are not particularly problematic when determining
how they work in the context of composing music. The first point of particular importance is
that a faithful application of these principles cannot involve an extremely rigorous systemisation
of the compositional process. Given that the works in the folio would fall into the category of
what Schuon calls ‘profane art’, the emphasis here is placed on creative freedom. It is also
noteworthy that Schuon specifically refers to the ‘indeterminate’ and ‘free’ qualities of art as
‘musicality’, implying that music in particular expresses this tendency. One could infer from this
that the rigorous formalisation inherent in classicism and also modernism, is an excess that
should be avoided. On the other hand, it is also clear that one must work within the confines of
traditional musical systems, and whilst it is not possible as such to work ‘within’ a living
tradition in the way that a composer of the middle ages would have, it is possible to incorporate
elements of their theoretical approach and to a lesser extent their spiritual discipline. More will
be said on these subjects in the discussion on working methods and compositional technique.
Schuon goes on to identify three elements that constitute a work of art which then form the basis
of his aesthetic criteria. These are: content, symbolism, and style. These can be defined in the
following way: content constitutes what the art intends to communicate, symbolism is the use of
forms corresponding to the supraformal dimensions of the content, and finally style consists of
the particular techniques used to realise these symbols in a tangible work.
Schuon goes on to outline how these elements form the foundation for aesthetic criteria for
traditional art in the following passage:
“Now if we start from the idea that perfect art can be recognized by three main criteria:
nobility of content - this being a spiritual condition apart from which art has no right to
83 Ibid., p. 80
31
exist - then exactness of symbolism or at least, in the case of profane works of art,
harmony of composition, and finally purity of style or elegance of line and color, we can
discern with the help of these criteria the qualities and defects of any work of art whether
sacred or not.” 84
This passage summarises all of the aesthetic considerations that Schuon takes into account when
evaluating a work of art. There are also a number of implications in this passage that need to be
addressed.
The first condition that Schuon proposes is ‘nobility of content’. This means that what the work
expresses must in itself be of spiritual value. This does not preclude art from expressing
seemingly everyday forms or emotions, provided that they are integrated into a perspective that
conforms to the criteria of nobility, uprightness, and rectitude. This criterion does exclude any
work of art that expresses what is base and ignoble, when it does so simply for the sake of
expressing these things and not by way of contrasting them with nobility.
The second criterion, ‘exactness of symbolism’, relates to the science of forms. Thus, the work
of art must express its content using forms which actually correspond to that content. It is on this
condition that the traditionalists condemn the religious art of the Renaissance and later periods,
given that its subject matter is religious but its formal language is humanistic and in some cases
grotesque. Schuon adds to this criterion, that “in case case of profane works of art,” in other 85
words art which does not address the sacred directly, this criterion can be replaced by “harmony
of composition.” This still relates to the science of forms but in this case rather than the
requirement being that the form express an archetypal reality through a metaphysical
correspondence determined by the sacred science of symbolism, it is only necessary that the
different elements in the work are not in irreconcilable conflict with each other, that is to say that
the work is internally coherent. It should be recalled that in this latter case, it is still necessary
84 Ibid., p. 99 85 Titus Burckhardt, ‘The Universality of Sacred Art’ in The Essential Titus Burckhardt, edited by William Stoddart, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 2003), p. 87
32
for the art to meet the requirement of nobility “which is a spiritual condition apart from which art
has no right to exist,” and therefore the fact that work does not directly express a sacred reality
does not mean that it can express just anything.
The third and final criterion Schuon gives is “purity of style or elegance of line and colour.” The
essential quality expressed in this statement is elegance, which requires a degree of facility and
skill in the treatment of materials on the part of the artist. The relationship of elegance to “purity
of style” is that it is the style, transmitted by tradition, that is the guarantee of aesthetic qualities.
In a case like the 21st century, where stylistic choices are made by the individual rather than
determined by tradition, it is necessary to revert to this criterion of elegance in determining how
one approaches stylistic considerations. With the above mentioned considerations in mind, the
criteria of art, as defined by Schuon can be summarised as nobility, harmony, and elegance.
These qualities then, will form the basis of the aesthetic approach for the compositional content
of this project.
It is only necessary to briefly summarise here how these qualities of nobility, harmony, and
elegance are to be considered in relation to the composition of music. Firstly, nobility precludes
the expression of sentiments that are excessively individualistic or expressionistic, and do not
possess a degree of detachment or objectivity. Whilst one could infer a critique of classicism
from Schuon’s assertion of the need for a degree of indeterminism in art, particularly in music,
one could infer from this criterion (nobility) a critique of certain trends in late romanticism and
particularly in expressionism. The second quality, harmony, requires that one does not introduce
irreconcilably contrasting elements, be they stylistic or otherwise. One could consider here the
specifically musical meaning of the term harmony and suggest that the introduction of
dissonances which are not subject to any form of ‘treatment’ in order to clarify their relationship
with the harmony should be avoided. This is not necessarily a critique of the highly dissonant
works of the late 19th century, where dissonance still possesses a relationship to a harmonic
structure, even when it is unresolved, however 20th century works which treat harsh dissonances
in the same way as the most harmonious intervals are undoubtedly problematic from this point of
33
view. Finally the quality of elegance, which relates to style, one again requires a modicum of
detachment and avoidance of needless excesses of contrast, dissonance, or sentiment.
For Schuon the role played by art, and therefore the significance of the science of forms, is
central to the preservation of tradition. It plays this role by infusing the formal language and
ambience of human society with metaphysical truth, thereby ensuring that individual members of
a human collective are not deprived of contact with the sacred, even if they are not consciously
aware of its metaphysical foundations. In this way traditional art is an essential complement to 86
theological dogmas which preserve the sacred within systematic, albeit limited formulations.
This is the reason why art must play a role in all human productions, and also why the decline of
the arts and the neglect of the artistic dimension of the production of everyday items and our
architectural surroundings is not merely the result of spiritual decadence but is also a secondary
cause of this decadence. With these considerations in mind the artist has a duty to attempt to
communicate something of beauty in a world which is increasingly deprived of it. 87 88
Application of Traditionalist Doctrine to Musical Composition: Part 2 - Application of
Schuon’s Principles to Composition
The extent to which this folio addresses the question of compositional technique, rather than
more general aesthetic principles, is informed by Schuon’s framework in which formal discipline
86 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Concerning Forms in Art’ in The Transcendent Unity of Religions, (Wheaton: Quest Books 1993), p. 62 87 “Beauty is a reflection of divine bliss, and since God is Truth, the reflection of His bliss will be that mixture of happiness and truth which is to be found in all beauty...Beauty mirrors happiness and truth. Without the element of ‘happiness’ there remains only bare form - geometrical, rhythmical or other - and without the element of ‘truth’ there remains only a wholly subjective enjoyment or, it might be said, luxury. Beauty stands between abstract form and blind pleasure, or rather so combines them as to imbue veridical form with pleasure and veridical pleasure with form.”, Frithjof Schuon, Spiritual Perspectives and Human Facts, trans. Mark Perry, Jean-Pierre Lafouge, James Cutsinger, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 2007), pp. 24-25 88 “This feeling for beauty, and so also a need for beauty, is natural in normal man and is indeed the very condition behind the detachment of the traditional artist in regard to the aesthetic quality of sacred work; in other words a major preoccupation with this quality would for him amount to a pleonasm. Not to feel the need for beauty is an infirmity, not unrelated to the inescapable ugliness of the machine age, which under under industrialism has become widespread; since it is impossible to get away from industrialism people make a virtue of this infirmity and calumniate both beauty and the need for it.”, Frithjof Schuon, Language of the Self, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom 1999), p. 81
34
and technique is significant, but without the work thereby becoming totally formalised and
deprived of ‘free’ elements. This concept underlies the compositional approach, which attempts
to balance the development of theoretical techniques, derived from traditional models, and the
relatively free application of more general aesthetic principles. Aside from the question of
compositional technique, it is also necessary to discuss the traditionalist position on the actual
working methods and preparations of the traditional artist. For example:
“In the ancient Church and in the Eastern Churches even down to our own times,
iconographers prepared themselves for their work by fasting, prayer, and sacraments,
adding their own humble and pious inspirations to the inspiration that had fixed the
immutable type of the image.” 89
This comment is made in relation to icon painters but the more general principle is that in order
to approach art in a traditional manner, one must take account of the condition of one’s own soul
before the creative process even begins. Although it is not problematic to approach a work that
is not specifically sacred with greater freedom than the icon painter has in relation to his model,
one is still required to approach the work with humility and with a soul that is subject to the
disciplines imposed by a sacred tradition.
The considerations from the previous section form the basis for a general framework that
governs the principles underlying the works contained in the portfolio. This framework is a
general overview. It consists of the following points: 90
1. Self discipline of the artist through the spiritual methods of sacred tradition
2. Formal discipline through derivation of technique from traditional models
3. Aesthetic discipline through application of principles derived from traditionalist literature
89 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Christian Art,’ World Wisdom, http://www.worldwisdom.com/uploads/flash/CH6_5A6L398HJI/index.html [accessed 29/01/2018] 90 The question of compositional techniques will be addressed in greater detail in the next section.
35
As for the first point, it is the concern of the artist and does not directly relate to the actual
product. Therefore it is not necessary to disclose details of this aspect of the project here. The
second point will be discussed in greater detail in the next section. The third point, concerns
aesthetic principles derived from traditionalist literature, in particular the works of Frithjof
Schuon. This subject has already been addressed and the following is a summary of some
related considerations not yet discussed.
The first principle is the derivation of technique from traditional models without thereby
depriving the artist of creative freedom and the ability to deploy intuition. Considerably more
freedom may be allowed than might be the case if one was working in the field of liturgical art.
In the case of this portfolio, even the pieces that use liturgical themes and texts are not intended
to be used in that context. Another point of interest here is that Schuon warns on numerous
occasions against art becoming excessively grandiose. This is particularly relevant to music
which was subject to a massive change in proportions in the 19th century, where it, from a
traditionalist point of view, vastly exceeded its traditional parameters. One could apply
Schuon’s principle here of understanding the intrinsic nature of an artform. Music, and what it
conveys. is dynamic, ephemeral, and abstract. Nineteenth century romanticism seems to confuse
music with architecture by trying to force this dynamic substance into large scale, static
structures. This development takes place in parallel with a multiplication of the instrumental
forces necessary to perform the works. What results is a music that is excessive in its
dimensions and does not conform to the intrinsic nature of the artform. These pitfalls are
avoided in the portfolio by an emphasis on small scale, succinct movements, even within larger
scale works. The longest single movements are the first and last movements of the string quartet,
Elivagar, which are approximately 8-9 minutes each. There is also an emphasis on a smaller
scale in relation to the use of instrumentation, with the string quartet being the largest
instrumental group used.
36
Application of Traditionalist Doctrine to Musical Composition: Part 3 - Theoretical and
Technical Considerations
“What lies at the very heart of all the arts is chiefly an application of the science of
rhythm under its different forms, a science which is itself immediately connected with
that of number. It must be clearly understood that when we speak of the science of
number, it is not a question of profane arithmetic as understood by the moderns, but of
that arithmetic to be found in the Kabbalah and in Pythagorism (the best known
examples), whose equivalent also exists, under varied expressions and with greater or
lesser developments, in all the traditional doctrines...
...As for music, it will surely not be necessary to insist on this, since its numerical basis is
still recognized by moderns themselves, distorted though it is through the loss of
traditional data; formerly, as can be seen especially well in the Far East, modifications
could only be introduced into music in consequence of certain changes occurring in the
actual state of the world in accordance with cyclical periods, for musical rhythms were at
once intimately linked with the human and social order and with the cosmic order, and in
a certain way they even expressed the connections between the one and the other. The
Pythagorean conception of the “harmony of the spheres” belongs to exactly the same
order of considerations.” 91
This passage, taken from Réné Guénon’s essay ‘The Arts and their Traditional Conception’
outlines the way in which traditionalist principles are applied specifically to music. The
principles at work in music are chiefly understood through their correspondence with numbers,
which in turn correspond to metaphysical principles. This understanding forms the basis for all
the traditional sciences of music, and is particularly evident in certain musical systems, such as
the classical music of India. Alain Daniélou, in his work, Introduction to the Study of Musical
91 Réné Guénon, ‘The Arts and Their Traditional Conception,’ World Wisdom, http://www.worldwisdom.com/public/viewpdf/default.aspx?article-title=The_Arts_and_their_Traditional_Conception_by_Rene_Guenon.pdf [accessed 29/01/2018]
37
Scales, undertook a detailed study of how these concepts for the basis of traditional musical 92
theory.
“All music is based on the relations of sounds, and a careful study of the numbers by
which these relations are ruled, brings us immediately into the almost forgotten science
of numerical symbolism. Through musical experience it is easy to see that numbers
correspond to abstract principles and that their application to physical reality follows
absolute and inescapable laws.
It is in music only that this connection between physical reality and metaphysical
principles is evident. Music was, therefore, justly considered by the ancients as the key to
all sciences and arts, the link between metaphysics and physics, through which the
universal laws and their multiple applications could be understood” 93
It is only possible to provide a very brief summary of Daniélou’s main points here. Firstly, he
declares that, due to the rudiments of music being governed by the metaphysical
correspondences produced by numerical ratios, it is a grave error to alter these ratios, even
slightly, thereby destroying their symbolic function. Daniélou thus regards the modern way of
dividing the octave into twelve equal parts to be based on a fundamental misunderstanding of the
nature of music, and a reduction of a natural, supra-rational order to a human, rational, system.
“...on account of the imperfection which is at the very basis of the world existence,
because if it were perfect it would immediately be reabsorbed into the infinite perfection,
just as the heart of man is not in the centre of his chest, as the axis of the Earth is
oblique, as the solar year does not coincide with the lunar year and thus are created the
cycles by which all existence is conditioned and human destinies measured; so, in the
same way, the development of twelve fifths (as that of the twelve months), instead of
bringing back the octave, will leave a difference, the comma, with which we shall have to
92 Danielou, op. cit. 93 Ibid., p. 1
38
negotiate, which will make every calculation complicated, and which will prevent us
from formulating those rigid and simple laws, attractive but inaccurate, in which our vain
reason delights. This comma, which the modern world tries so hard to ignore, represents,
for those who can understand it, all the difference between what is finite and what is
indefinite.” 94
Daniélou then demonstrates how the traditional methods of tuning, either by deriving tunings
directly from a harmonic series, or from a cycle of fifths, produce scales which are capable of
expressing the metaphysical correspondences in question and therefore do not deprive music of
its most potent means of expression. For Daniélou the additional possibilities afforded by equal
temperament, such as remote modulations, are insignificant compared to the inherent power of
correctly tuned intervals.
The framework provided by Daniélou raises numerous problems in determining how to approach
composition in a context where the use of equal temperament, and equal tempered instruments, is
widespread. The approach to this problem in the context of the portfolio, given that the concern
is not the development of theory or technique but rather a creative application of these principles,
is to solve these problems in the most direct and simple way. This simply involves avoiding the
use of instruments that are restricted to equal temperament, such as the piano, and using modal 95
systems to govern pitch which encourage the instrumentalist to conform to natural tunings
without specifically instructing them to do so. In other words the treatment of pitch is kept
within relatively diatonic modes, chromaticism is largely avoided, and modulations and
harmonic progression are minimised. The folio contains exceptions to the rules outlined above
but they nonetheless form the basis of how the problem of tuning is resolved without having to
ask musicians to learn new techniques or having to develop complex tuning systems.
94 Ibid., p. 7 95 The piano is used is two of the smaller scale works (The Lights of Ibrahim and Songs of Sorrow and Light) which were composed at an early stage of the project.
39
So the general approach to treatment of pitch in the folio may be defined as ‘modal symbolism’,
in which different modes are employed as the primary means of defining the expressive character
of a section of music. This approach is particularly emphasised in The Lights of Ibrahim , which
was composed early in the candidature and thus uses a piano which was abandoned for most of
the later works. Contrapuntal textures are occasionally employed although complex counterpoint
does not form a major component of the works.
The approach to the treatment of rhythm is given particular attention in some of the pieces in the
folio. Aside from the conventional use of rhythmic cycles, additional techniques that are used
are the construction of thematic rhythmic ideas from rhythmic modes, and the use of various
ways of creating ratios between rhythmic layers that relate to the ratios governing pitch. As for
the latter technique, this can be done through the well known technique of polyrhythms, or
through the larger scale process of repeating rhythmic cycles of different lengths occurring
simultaneously (a type of cross-rhythm), or through both of these processes occurring
simultaneously. Greater detail on how these techniques are employed will be given in the
analysis of the pieces from the folio.
In accordance with Schuon’s concept of music being a dynamic substance that is better suited to
compact forms. The forms utilised in the folio aim for succinctness and simplicity. The Lights
of Ibrahim provides an example of how the use of short, simple forms can be combined with a
developmental approach by utilising the same material in multiple movements. The string
quartet Elivagar uses somewhat more extended forms which are effectively fantasias in the sense
that they do not follow a rigid form but develop emotively and were composed in an
improvisational manner. The preference for smaller scale works also extends to the
instrumentation, which is deliberately minimal. It is worth noting that the composer has always
had a preference for chamber music over orchestral music, however this approach is also
informed by Schuon’s commentary on the nature of art and music in particular.
40
Chapter 3: The Lights of Ibrahim for Piano Trio
The Lights of Ibrahim was composed early in 2016 for the Endeavour Trio (Paul Dean, Trish
O’Brien, and Stephen Emmerson) as part of a competition run by the Accompanists Guild of
South Australia. The piece placed equal first and was recorded by the Endeavour Trio during a
live performance on the 31st of July, 2016. The name of the piece is a reference to a passage in
the Qu’ran in which the prophet Abraham apparently identifies God with a star, the moon, and
the sun, before recognising that God cannot be identified with any finite object. This passage is
understood in Sufi literature to be an analogy for progressive stages of spiritual realisation, and
the piece intends to utilise modal symbolism to convey this inward journey towards spiritual
realisation.
41
{
{
{
Clarinet in Bb
Violoncello
Piano
p
Misterioso con rubato q = ca72
pp
°
mf p mf mp mf mp
Andante e = e
11
mf f mp p p mp
mp mf ppp
mf
mf
mp
19
p
mp
*
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
9
8
9
8
9
8
9
8
&∑ ∑ ∑
5
1. The Vision
Score in C
The Lights of Ibrahim
Thomas Devereux
?∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&∑
3 3
3
”“
&∑ ∏∏
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
3
3
3
&∑
?∑ ∑
3
&
“: ;
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∑ ∑
”“
3
&
?
&
5
5
?
&
”“
∑ ∑ ∑?
&
?
&
œ œ#
œ œ
œ œ ˙ ™Œ
œ#œ# œ œ#
˙# ˙ ™ œ
œ ™œ
J
˙ ™
œœbœ
œœœ#
œnœœ#
œ#œ#
œn ˙˙# ™
™ ˙˙ ™
™ ˙˙## ™
™ ˙˙ ™
™ ˙˙ ™
™ ˙˙ ™
™ ˙˙ ™
™
œœ#œ
œœ#œ#
œ#
œœn
œ#
œœn
˙˙˙ ™
™™ ˙
˙˙ ™
™™ ˙
˙̇
˙
#
###
™™™™ ˙
˙̇
˙ ™™™™ ˙
˙̇
˙ ™™™™
˙˙ ™
™ ˙˙ ™
™
˙ ™
˙ ™ ˙ œ œ ˙ œœb ˙ ™
˙ ™ œ ™
˙ ™ œ œ#
œ
œ œ#
œ œœ
œ ˙ ™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
œ
œ
™
™ ˙˙ ™
™ œœ ™
™
˙˙ ™
™œœ# œ œ
œ œœ ˙ ™
˙
˙˙# ™
™™ ˙
˙˙ ™
™™
Œ œœ#œœnœbœ œ œ ™
˙˙ ™
™ ˙˙˙ ™
™™ ˙
˙˙ ™
™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
œ
œ
J
œbœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
œbœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
œbœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ ˙ œ œ# ˙ œœ œ
œ œœb ˙ œ œ œ
œ œœb ˙ ™ œ ™
˙ ™ œ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™
œœ œ œ œ#
œb
j
œ ™ œ
j
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™
‰
œ
œnœbœœnœ#œœœ œ ™
˙˙
™™
œœ
™™
˙˙
™™
œœ
™™
œ
œ
J
œbœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
œbœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
œbœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
œbœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙
™
™
œ
œ
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
œ
œ
™
™
42
{
{
{
{
q = 72
25
flessibile, espress.
mp
p
p
29
pp
molto espress.
mp
Espressivo q = 72
36
p
p
flessibile
°
mf mp mf mp
43
mf mp mf mp
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
&Ú ∑ ∑ ∑
?U
&Ú
”“
&Ú
&∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ b
?∑ ∑ ∑
b
&
5
rit.
∑
“: ;
b
3 3
3
&
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∑?
b
3
3
3
&b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
3
2. The Star
?
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&b
U
U
5
?
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&b
5 55
6
6
?
b
&b
?
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
W
e ee
eb e ee e# e e# e e e e e
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
Œ
œ ™œ
J
˙ ™ œ
œ#
œ# œ#
œ#
˙
˙˙ ™
™
™ ˙
˙˙ ™
™
™˙˙̇˙̇
#
#
###
™™™™™
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™œ
œ œn
œ# œ ˙˙# ™
™ ˙˙ ™
™ œœbœ
œœœ#
œnœœ#
œ#œ#
œn
˙˙̇˙̇
™™™™™ ˙
˙̇˙̇
™™™™™
˙
˙
˙
n
n ™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
œœ#œ
œœ#œ#
œ#
œœn
œ#
œœn
œ œœ ˙ œ œ
œœ œ œ ˙
Œ
˙ ™
œ œ
œ œ œ ˙
ee e
ee e
e e ˙ ™
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™™
ee e
ee e
œ
œ
œ ˙ œ œ œœ œ ˙ œ
œ œœ œ œ
Ó
œ
œ
œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œœ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ
œœœ ™
œ œ
j
˙ ™ w ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ w
˙
˙
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
2
43
{
{
{
{
p mf pp
51
57
mf
mf
pp p
Con brio q = 120
65
pp p
pp mf
°
p
72
flessibile
pmp
*
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&b
3
?
b
&b
?
?
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
&b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
#
?
b
3
∑&
#
?
b &
#
?
b
#
&
#
3. The Moon
&
#
&
#
”“
3
3
?#∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&
# U
&
#U U
∑?
&
#
U
∏∏∏∏∏∏
”“
?#U
˙ Œ
œ
œ
œ œ ™ œ
J
œ œœ œ ˙ œ œ œ
J
œ œœ
J
w
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ w
˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙ ™
˙ œ œ œ œ œ˙ œ œ œ œ œ
œ ˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙˙
™™
˙˙
™™
˙
˙
™™
˙
˙
™™
˙˙
™™
˙˙
™™
˙˙
™™
˙˙
™™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
Ó ˙ w w w w w w
Ó
˙
˙
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
œ œ
œ œ
˙ wœ œ
œ œœ œ œ
œœ
œ
œ ˙ œ œ œ œ
œ œ
œ œ
œœ
œ œ
œ œ œœœœ
œ ˙˙
W ˙ ˙ w
œ œ˙ ™
W
W
˙
˙
˙
˙
w
w
ee
e ee
e
ee
e ee
e ˙œ
œ w
Ó
˙
˙
˙
ee
e ee
e
ee
e ee
e
Ó Ó œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
3
44
{
{
{
{
mf
mp
76
mp
mp
82
mp
mf
86
pp
90
pp
flessibile
p
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
&
#
3
3
? #∑
33
&
#
∏∏∏∏∏∏
”“ ”“
∏∏∏∏∏∏
”“
∑
∏∏∏∏∏∏
”“
3
?#
&
#
∑ ∑
? #
.
..
.
..
.
..
.
.. .
..
..
. ..
.
&
#
∑
3 3
?#
&
?
3
3
&
#
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
? # ..
.
..
.
.
..
.
..
.
..
.
.. .
..
..
.
..
.
&
#?
?#
&
#
∑ ∑
##
###
##
? #
&
? ##
###
##
?#
&
##
###
##
U
?# ##
###
##
œœ œ œ
œ ˙ Ó Œ
œ
œ
˙ ™ œœœ
˙ ™ œ
œ ˙ ™ œ œ œ ™ œ
J˙
Ó Œ œ œ œw
Ó
œ
Jœ ™ œ
Jœ
˙ ™ ˙œ ™ œ
J
Ó
˙
˙
˙
Ó
œœœ
œœ
w
Ó
˙
˙
˙
Ó
˙
˙
˙
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
w w
˙ ™ œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™
™ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙
˙
˙ ™
™œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙
™
™
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙
˙
˙
™
™
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œœ œ œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œœ
œœ
œœ œ œ
œœ
˙
˙ ™
™œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™
™ œ
œ
œ
œw
w
w
w
˙
˙ ™
™œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™
™ œ
œ
œ
œw
w
w
w
W
w w
W
W
ww
ww
ee
e ee
e
ee
e ee
e
w
w
w
w ee
e ee
e
ee
e ee
e
4
45
{
{
{
Maestoso q = 72
93
ppp
°
104
mff mf
mf
111
f
f
*
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&
##
###
## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
4. The Sun
? ##
###
##
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&
##
###
## ∑
”“
?
33
3
?##
###
##
∑ ∑ ∑&
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
?
&
##
###
## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
? ##
###
##
3
3
?##
###
## &
”“
?
&
”“
?
?##
###
## &
?
&
?
&
##
###
## ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
#
? ##
###
##
#
3
?##
###
##
#
?##
###
##
attacca
#
œ œ
œ œ
œ ˙ œ œnœn ™ œn
J œnœ œ
œ œœ ˙ œ œ ™ œ
J
œœœ
œ ™ œœœœ œ œ ™œœœ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
˙
˙
˙
™™™
œ œ
œ œ
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™œ œ
œ œ œ ˙ œ œ ™ œ
J
œœ œ
œ ™ œ œ œ œ
˙˙ ™
™˙˙˙˙ ™
™™™
˙
˙
™
™ ˙˙ ™
™˙˙˙˙ ™
™™™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙˙˙˙ ™
™™™
˙
˙n
n ™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙˙˙˙ ™
™™™
˙
˙n
n ™
™
˙
˙
™
™
œ œ ™œ œ œ ˙ ™
˙ ™ ˙n ™˙ ™ ˙n ™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙˙˙n
nn
™™™
˙
˙
™
™
˙˙˙n
nn
™™™
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
˙n ™
˙n ™
˙n ™
˙n ™
˙n ™
˙n ™
˙n ™
˙n ™
5
46
{
{
{
{
Maestoso q = 72
117
f mp
f
°
mf
accel. Brilliante q = 96
127
pcresc.
mf
p
cresc.
f
p f
134
*
mff
137
f
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&
#
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
5. The One
? #
?#∑
&
”“ 5
?
&
”“
?#
&
?
5
&
&
#
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
3
? #
&
#
“: ;
?
&
&
#?
&
?
&
&
#
3 3
? #
&
#?
”“
&
3 3
3
3
&
#?
&
3
3
3
3
&
# .>
? #
.>
3
&
#
”“”“
?
.>3 3
3
3
&
#?
&
?
.>
3
3
3
3
w w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
www
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
www
wwww
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙ ˙
˙
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œb
b w
w ww
w
w
w
w
w
w
˙
˙
˙
˙wwww
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙
˙
˙œ
œ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œb
b w
w
˙
˙
˙
˙
w ˙ ™œ
œ œ
w
w
ææw
ææw
ææw
ææw œ
œœœœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
wwww
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œb
b œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œb
b
˙
˙
wwww
ww
wwww
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
b
b
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
b
b
˙
˙
wwww
w
w
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ™œ
J
œœb œ
œ w
œ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œ
œ ™œb
j
œnœb
œ
œœ
œ#
œnœ
œ#
œ#œ#
œn wwwwnn
ww
œœ
œ
œœ#
œ#
œ
œœn
œ#
œœn
wwwwn
n
w
w
w w w
œ Œ Ó
œœb œ
˙ œœ
w w œ
Œ Ó
œnœbœ
œœœ#
œnœœ#
œ#œ#
œn
Óœnœnœœ
œœœœn
wwww
œœ Œ Ó
œœœ
œœ#œ#
œ
œœn
œ#
œœn
œœœnœœœnœœ
Ó
wwww
œ
œ
Œ Ó
6
47
Treatment of Pitch Material
The modal symbolism of the piece is partially informed by information given by Daniélou on
how particular intervals are understood in the modal system of Northern India, although the
modes do not deliberately refer to any particular ragas. The modes that are used in each
movement, along with their significance, are as follows:
Movements 1 and 5
Figure 3.1 The Lights of Ibrahim: Mode derived from harmonic series
This mode is derived directly from the harmonic series and is intended to symbolise both the
beginning and the end of the spiritual journey.
Movement 2
This mode is a minor pentatonic used frequently in East Asian music, although the remaining
two notes of the standard minor mode appear occasionally as passing tones and other
non-emphasised notes.
Figure 3.2 The Lights of Ibrahim: Minor mode
The technique of placing emphasis on specific notes in a mode, and of including certain notes
only in specific types of melodic movement is derived from the modal techniques used in Indian
48
music. This is a simple example of this technique which is one aspect of the more nuanced and
complex treatment of modes in that musical system (in comparison with Western classical
music).
Movement 3
This mode is intended to evoke the moon. In order to do so it emphasises the interval of the
fourth, which is understood to have a ‘lunar’ quality in the modal system of Northern India,
whereas the fifth has a ‘solar’ quality. The emphasis of the perfect fourth is reinforced by the 96
gesture in bars 72 and 92.
Figure 3.3 The Lights of Ibrahim: Mode derived from 4ths
Movements 4 and 5
The fourth movement uses a Lydian mode in F-sharp, whereas the fifth movement uses the mode
derived from the harmonic series (of C) that was used in the first movement. The intention of
this harmonic and modal shift is to make the fourth movement as ‘bright’ as possible, since it
evokes the sun. The Lydian mode is inherently ‘brighter’ than the natural harmonic mode due to
its raised seventh, and here it is in the ‘sharpest’ key in relation to C. The key of F-sharp was
also chosen for dramatic effect given that it is the most remote key from C, harmonically
speaking, and is therefore a logical choice of harmonic region to create the greatest dramatic
tension.
96 Alain Danielou, The Ragas of Northern Indian Music, (London: Barne & Rockliff, 1968), p. 41
49
Non-modal material
The modes given above form the basis of most of the melodic and harmonic material in the
piece. One notable exception to this is found in the first 15 bars of the piece. The movement
begins with a gesture in the piano that consists of a sequence of chords built from alternating
tritones and fourths, with the roots of the chords moving down in minor thirds. Note that each
pair of chords contains all 12 notes of the chromatic scale.
Figure 3.4 The Lights of Ibrahim: Harmonies based on tritones and fourths
This type of voicing was influenced more by Scriabin’s mystic chord than by Schoenberg,
although the influence of Schoenberg becomes clear from what follows.
This piano gesture is followed by melodic (clarinet) and harmonic (piano) material derived from
the following 12-tone row.
Figure 3.5 The Lights of Ibrahim: Tone Row
The first five notes of this melodic line also form a motif which recurs throughout the piece,
adjusted to fit within the respective modes. The significance of this motif is underlined by its use
at the very beginning of the piece here, and at the beginning of the third and fourth movements.
50
The use of these harmonies and a tone row may seem to run counter to many of the statements
made in regard to the treatment of musical material in the second chapter. The purpose of
deploying these techniques here was to create a maximal contrast with the modal material which
immediately follows it. Thus these techniques are only employed fleetingly and for dramatic
effect. This is an example of how certain modernist techniques may be used, sparingly and with
caution, when a certain effect is required.
Treatment of Form and Thematic Material
Form
Both the treatment of form and thematic material are deliberately kept simple enough so as to not
require significant comment. The individual movements are often small enough in their
dimensions that it is somewhat misleading to use the term ‘form’ given that it implies an internal
structure consisting of multiple parts. Despite these reservations the following observations can
be made about the formal structure of the movements:
First Movement (The Vision) - A (Bars 1-15) B (Bars 16-25) A (Bars 26 - 35). Note that
the repeat of section A uses the original material in retrograde rather than being an exact
repetition.
Second Movement (The Star) - A (Bars 36 - 56) B/Coda (Bars 57 - 64)
Third Movement (The Moon) - A (Bars 65 - 73) B (Bars 74 - 92)
Fourth/Fifth Movements (These movements combine to form an extended coda
consisting of repeated statements of the main thematic material)
51
Thematic Material
The piece utilises two main motivic ideas, the first of which (motif A) appears for the first time
with the first entry of the Clarinet in bar 4 as was stated above.
Figure 3.6 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A
Motif A consists of the first five notes shown in Figure 3.6. In this example the motif is
extended to form a twelve tone row, however in subsequent appearances the melodic line is
extended with pitch material from the mode being employed in the movement in question.
Figure 3.7 shows the next appearance of motif A in bar 18 now using modal pitch material to
continue the melodic line.
Figure 3.7 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A extension
The second movement, despite being based entirely on the second motivic idea (B) opens with
motif A in inversion.
52
Figure 3.8 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A inversion
Motif A returns at the beginning of the third movement, which combines both of the major
themes.
Figure 3.9 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A variation
Here the theme is also extended using a sequential pattern made up of the first four notes of the
motif. Note that the intervals are altered in the second repetition of the sequence to
accommodate the mode.
Figure 3.10 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A sequence
53
The fourth movement begins, in the Lydian mode on F#. Firstly recalling the twelve tone row
from the first movement, although it is left incomplete. This is then followed by an extension of
motif A which is stated twice before the transition to the fifth movement.
Figure 3.11 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A in F# Lydian
Motif A forms the basis of the final movement of the piece. This statement recalls the treatment
in the first movement although with a different texture being provided by the piano.
Figure 3.12 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A variation
The following sequential pattern prepares the final climactic statement of the theme:
Figure 3.13 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A sequence
54
The final statement in the clarinet is extended with a fast run that leads directly to the conclusion
of the piece.
Figure 3.14 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif A variation
The second main thematic idea (motif B) consists of a melodic figure rising by a major second
and then a fourth, followed by a turn with a triplet rhythm. This idea is introduced in the first
movement in bar 25.
Figure 3.15 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif B foreshadowing
This idea forms the basis of a more extended melodic theme played by the clarinet in the second
movement.
Figure 3.16 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif B extended melodic theme
55
This theme reappears once more in the third movement with the piano and cello providing an
accompaniment as well as ornamentation for the main melody.
Figure 3.17 The Lights of Ibrahim: Motif B variation
56
Treatment of Rhythmic Material
The rhythmic dimension does not, for the most part, play a thematically significant role in this
piece and thus does not require significant comment. The frequent use of quintuplets (and
triplets), as well as the extension of phrases across barlines, is intended to give the melodic
material a sense of freedom and fluidity which is not conducive to a careful systemisation of
rhythm. One feature of note is the isorhythmic accompaniment in the piano in the second
movement. This isorhythm is a recurring pattern of nineteen beats.
Figure 3.18 The Lights of Ibrahim: Isorhythm
57
Chapter 4: Élivágar for String Quartet
This piece combines ideas accumulated over the duration of the candidature and which were
mostly composed on the guitar, reworked as a solo piano piece and finally arranged for string
quartet. The melodic and harmonic language of the piece is relatively simple, being related to
earlier influences such as certain subgenres of heavy metal and folk music. This treatment of
pitch is however still aligned with the principles underpinning the folio, being primarily modal
with minimal harmonic movement. The treatment of form is determined intuitively,
corresponding to the needs of the thematic material. Of perhaps greater interest is the treatment
of rhythm, which was only incorporated into this final version of the piece. The rhythmic
language, particularly in the first movement, combines short rhythmic modes with larger
cross-rhythms which correspond to ratios derived from the harmonic relationships in the
thematic material.
58
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
Violin
Violin
Viola
Violoncello
ppp
Flessibile espressivo
mp
espress.
p
pp
2
mp
pp
pp
mf p
pp
Moderato q = c. 96
3
p
legato
mp
pp mp
pp pp
7
mf mp mp
pp p
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&bb
b
o o o
”“o o
Élivágar
I
Thomas Devereux
&bb
b ∑
Bbb
b
3
3
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b .
U
&bb
b ∑ ∑
&bb
b
.
.
.
.
.
Bbb
b∑ ∑
?
bb
b
pizz. arco pizz.
&bb
b
.......
. . . . .
. . . . .
. ......
..
...
..
&bb
b
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
arco
. . . . .
. . . . .
. .
pizz. arco
∑~
~n
œn
~n
œn
~
œ
~œ
œ œœ œ œ
œb ˙ ™ œœœb˙ œœ
œœ ˙ œ œ œb
œ œ œœ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œœ ™ œœ
œ ™ œ œœw
W W
~W
œ
J
œ œœ ˙
w œœ œ
œ ˙œœ
œ œœœœ W
W
W
œ œœœœ
œ œœœœ œ
œœ
œ w
Ó ≈
œœœ
œ ˙
Ó
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœ ˙ ™ w
w œ
Œ Óœ
˙ ™
w
Ó ≈
œœœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ wœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ ˙ ™ ˙
˙ wÓ Œ ‰
œ
j
œ
˙ ™ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ ˙
œ
Œ Ó Œ ‰œ
J
59
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
pp
11
p
pp
pp
15
p mf
p
pp
pp pp pp pp
19
mppp
pp pp pp pp
pp
pp
A temporit.
23
pp pp p
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&bb
b
.....
.....
..
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . .
&bb
b
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
pizz. arco
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . .
&bb
b
.....
.....
...
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . .
&bb
b
.
.
. ..
..
.
.
3 3
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
pizz. arco
.. . . .
. . . . .
. . .
&bb
b
. . . . .
. .
. . .
. . . . . . . .
. .
. . .
. . . . . . . .
. .
. . .
. . . . . . . .
. .
. . .
. . .
&bb
b
.
.
. .
.
.
.
.3 3
Bbb
b
. . . .
.
. . . . .
. . . .
.
. . . . .
. . . . . . .
?
bb
b . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . .
&bb
b
. . . . .
. .
. . .
. . . . . . . .
. .
. . .
∑ ∑
. . .
&bb
b
.
.
.
.
.
∑ ∑
3
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . .
.
. . . . .
. . . .
.
. . . . .
∑ ∑
. . . .
?
bb
b . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . .
w œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœ ˙ œ
œœœ
œ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ ™œ œ ™ œ ˙ w œ
œ ™œ ™ œ
œ w
œ ™ œ
œ ˙
œ
Œ Ó ‰œ ™
˙ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ
wœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
w w œœ œ œ œ œ
w
˙
œ
Œ w
œ
˙ œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
w œ œ ˙ ™œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœœ
œ œ œœœ œœ
œœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœœ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
2
60
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mp
27
mp
p
mf
31
mf
p
35
p
p
mf pp mf pp mf pp
39
mf
pp
mf
pp mf
pp
p
mf pp mf pp mf pp
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b .
.
.
.
. .
.
.
.
3
&bb
b
”“
&bb
b
Bbb
b
pizz. arco . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b . .
.
.
.
. .
.
.
3 3
&bb
b
“: ;
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . .. . . . .
. . . . .
. . .
?
bb
b
.
. .
.
.
.
. .
.
3 3
&bb
b
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
. .
.
3
?
bb
b .
.
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . .. . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . .
œœ ˙ ™ w œ
œ ™œ ™ ˙ ˙
˙
œœ ˙ ™ w œ
œ ™œ ™ ˙ ˙
˙
Œ ≈
œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœ œœœ œ œ œœ˙
Œ ≈
œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œœ œœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
w w œœ ˙ ™ w
w w
œœ ˙ ™ w
œ
œ ˙ w Œ ≈
œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œ
œœ œ œ œ
œ w w w
œ
œœ œ œ œ
œ w w w
œ
J
œ œ
J
œ
J
œ ™ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œœœ œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ œ œ œ œ
w œ ˙ ™ œ ˙ ™
œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œ œ œ œœœ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ œ
œœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœ œ œ œ œœœœ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ
3
61
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mf pp mf pp mf pp
43
mf pp mf pp mf pp
mf pp mf pp mf pp
mf pp mf pp
rit.
46
mf pp
mf
pp
mf pp mf pp
mpmf mf
p
Lento
49
mp mf mf p
pp
pp
senza vibrato
pp simile
Lento flessibile
55
pp
senza vibrato
pp simile
pp
5
16
5
16
5
16
5
16
&bb
b
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
.
.
. .
.
.
.
3
?
bb
b . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . .. . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
. .
.
.
.
.
3
3
?
bb
b . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
&bb
b
U
3
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
U3
3
Bbb
b
U
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
U
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
b∑ ∑
œ˙ ™ œ
˙ ™ œ ˙ ™
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ ˙ ™ œ˙ ™ w
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœ
œœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœ
œœ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
˙
˙ œ œ œ œ˙ œ
œ œœœ ˙ œ œ œ
œ œ ™ œ œ w w
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ˙ œ
œ œœœ ˙ œ œ œ
œ œ ™ œ œ w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ w w
w w w
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w w w w w
w w ww
w ww w
w w w w
w
w w ww
w w w w
w w w w
w
W
4
62
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
p
Agitato e = c. 216
58
p
70
mp
mp
82
mp
p
mf
94
5
16
5
16
5
16
5
16
&bb
b
&bb
b ∑
Bbb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
pizz.
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
b∑
&
?∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑
&
?∑ ∑
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰œœœœœ œ
j≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰œœœœœ œ
j≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœ
œ
œ
œ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰œœœœœ œ
j≈‰
œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœ
œ
œ
œ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰œœœœœ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœ
œ
œ
œ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œ
j≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœ
œ
œ
œ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ œœœ
œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰œœœœœ œ
j≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœ
œ
œ
œ œ
J
≈‰
œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰œœœœœ œ
j≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœœœœ œ
J
≈‰
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ œœœœ
œ
œ
œœœœ œœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œœœ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
5
63
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
p
106
f
118
f
f
f
mp
130
p
mp
p
142
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&
?
&bb
b
. . . . . .. .
&bb
b
. . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b∑ ∑
arco
. .. .
. . . .
&bb
b
. . . .. . . .
&bb
b
. . . .. . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b
. .. .
. . . .
. . . .
&bb
b
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . .
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ œ
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
Jœ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ
œœœ
œ œœœ
œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œ
œ
œœ œœœœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ œœœ
œ
œœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ ™
J ‰
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œ ™
J
œ
J
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœ œ œœ œœ œ œœ
œ ™
J ‰ œ
r
œ
œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ
œ
œ
œœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ
œ œ œœ
œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œœœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœœ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ
œœ œ œ œ
œœ œ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœ œ œ œ
œœ œ œ œ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ
6
64
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
p mf p mf p
153
pmf p mf p
p mf p mf p
p mf p mf p
mf p
163
mf
p
mf p
mf p
pp
Lento
Allegro q = c. 120
173
pp p
pp
pp
181
sf p sf p
sf p sf p
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&bb
b
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b
U
∑
U
∑ ∑
&bb
b
U
∑
U
Bbb
b
U
∑
U
∑ ∑
?
bb
b
U
∑
U
∑ ∑
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ œ œ
œ
œ
œ œœbœ
œbœ œ
œ
œœ œn œ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ
œœbœ œ
œ
œ œœbœœ œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœœœœ
œœbœœœ
œœbœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œœ
œ
œ œœbœ
œbœ œ
œ
œœ œn œ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ
œ œ œbœ
œb
œœb œ œ œ
œœ œ
œ œ œ œ œbœ
œb
œœb œ œ œ
œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œb
œœbœ
œ œb
œœbœ
œ œ
œœœ
œ œb
œœbœ
œ œb
œœbœ
œ
w w w w w
w w w w w œœœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
w wb w wb w
w wb w wb w
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
7
65
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mf cantabile
185
mf
sf p
sf p
189
sf p
sf p
f
193
f
sf p sf p
sf p sf p
197
sf p
sf p
&bb
b ∑
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b ∑
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
œ
J
œ œ œ œ
J
˙ œ œ ˙˙
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ œœœb
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœ œœœœœœœœ
œœœœ œ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœœœ œœœ œœœœ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
J
œ œ œ œ
J
˙ œ œ ˙˙
œœœœ
œ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœb
œœœœ
œ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœœœœœ œœœ œœœ œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ œ œœœœœ œœœœœœœ
œœœœœ œ œ œœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œœœ œ œ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
w ˙ ™™ œ
j
œœœ
œb
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œb
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œb
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œb
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ œœ œ œœœœ œœœ œ œœœ œœœ œœœ œœœœ œ
œœœœœ
œœœ œœ œ œœœœ œœœ œœœœ œœœ œœœ œ
œœœ œœ œ œœœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ œœœœ œœœ œ œœ œœ œ œœœœ œœœ œœœ œœ œ œœœœ œœœ
8
66
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mf cantabile
201
mf
sf p
sf p
sf p
sf p
204
207
mp
sf p
sf p
210
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . .5
5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b ∑
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . .
. . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
. . . .5
5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
˙ ™ œ œ w ˙ ™ œ œ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œbœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œb œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
w w ˙ ™ œ œ
œbœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œbœœœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œ œ œœ
œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
w w
œ œ œœ
œbœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œbœ
œœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œbœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œb œ œ œ œ
œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œbœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œbœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œb œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
9
67
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
rit.
213
pp
pp
pp
Più mosso e = c. 264
217
mf
f
f
225
f
mp
mp
229
7
16
7
16
7
16
7
16
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . .
5
?
bb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
U
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
Bbb
b
U
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑.>. . . .
>. . . .
>. . . .
>. . . .
>. . . .
>
?
bb
b
U
&bb
b ∑ ∑
&bb
b ∑
Bbb
b
. . . .>. . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b
.>
. . .
.>
. . .
.>
. . .
&bb
b ∑
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b
.>
. . .
.>
. . .
.>
. . .
.>
. . .
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœ
w w
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w w
w
w
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
w œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ
œ
J
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
˙
˙
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œœœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ œœœ
œ œœ
œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
˙
˙
˙
˙
œ
œ
J
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
˙
˙
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œœœ
œœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
10
68
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
ff
233
ff
f
f
237
mp ff
241
mp ff
mp ff
mp ff
mp ff mp ff
245
mp ff mp ff
mp ff mp ff
mp ff mp ff
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b
.>
. . .
.>
. . .
.>
. ..
.>
. . .
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. .
.
. . . . .
.
. . .
?
bb
b
.>
. ..
.>
. . .
.>
. ..
.>
. . .
&bb
b
.>
.>
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . . . . . .
.
. . .
?
bb
b
.>
. ..
.>
. . .
.>
. ..
.>
. . .
&bb
b
.>
.>
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. .
.
. . . . .
.
. .
?
bb
b
.>
. ..
.>
. . .
.>
. ..
.>
. . .
˙
˙
˙
˙ œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œœœ
œœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœ œ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœ œ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ
˙˙ ™™ w
wœ
˙˙ ™™
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœ œ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœ œ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
ww
œ
˙˙ ™™ w
wœ
˙˙ ™™
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
11
69
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mp
p
rit.
249
mp p
mp
p
mp
p
Moderato
253
pp
pp
257
mp
mf p
261
mf p
mp
mp
&bb
b
. . . . . . . . .
&bb
b
Bbb
b
. . .
. . . . . . . . .
?
bb
b
.>
. .. . . . . . . . . .
&bb
b
. .
∑ ∑ ∑
.
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑
Bbb
b . . .
?
bb
b. . .
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b ∑
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
ww œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœ œ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ
œ
œœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœœ œœœœœ œœœ œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
w ˙˙
w
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
Ó
œœ w ˙
˙w
˙ œœ w ˙
˙w
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
12
70
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mf p
265
mf p
mf p
269
mf p
mf p
273
mf p
mf p pp
rit.
277
mf p pp
p pp
p pp
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
> >
>
>
>
&bb
b
U U
##
#
&bb
b
U
∑
##
#
Bbb
b
U
∑##
#
?
bb
b
> >
>
>
> U
U##
#
w
æææw
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææw
w
æææw
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææw
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
æææw
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææw
æææw
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææw
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
æææw
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææw
æææw
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææ˙
æææw
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
æææw
w ˙˙
w w
~w
~w
æææw
w ˙˙
w w
w
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
w w ˙ ˙ ˙˙
w
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
w w ˙
˙˙
˙ w
w
13
71
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mp
Allegro quasi violino
284
mp
mp
mp
292
pp
pp
pp
mf
Più mosso
301
mfcantabile
mf
mf
p
rit.
309
p
p
p
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
&
##
#
II
&
##
# pizz.
∑ ∑
B##
#
pizz.
∑ ∑
?##
#
pizz.
∑ ∑
&
##
# ##
&
##
#
∑ ∑
arco
##
B##
#
∑ ∑
arco
##
?##
#∑ ∑
arco
##
&
##
&
##
B##
pizz.
∑ ∑
?##
pizz.
∑ ∑
&
##
U
∑
U
b
&
##
U
∑
U
b
B## ∑ ∑
arco
U
∑
U
b
?## ∑ ∑
arco
U
∑
U
b
œœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œÓ Œ
œŒ Ó
œ œÓ Œ
œŒ Ó
œ
œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ
œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œÓ Œ
œŒ Ó
œ œÓ Œ
œŒ Ó
œ ˙ ™
œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ ˙ ™
œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ œ
Ó Œ
œ
Œ Ó
œ ˙ ™
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙ œ ˙ œ ˙ œ ˙œ
˙ œ ˙ œ˙ œ
˙œ
œ
œ Ó Œ
œ
œ Œ Ó
œ
œ
œ
œ Ó Œ
œ
œ Œ Ó
œ
œ
œ Ó Œ œ Œ Ó œ œ Ó Œ œ Œ Ó œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ œ ˙ œ˙
œ
˙
œ
˙ œ ˙ œ˙ œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
œ Ó Œ
œ
œ Œ Ó
œ
œ
œ
œ Ó Œ
œ
œ Œ Ó
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™™
œ Ó Œ œ Œ Ó œ œ Ó Œ œ Œ Ó œ ˙ ™
14
72
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
pespress.
Lento ma non troppo, flessibile
319
pespress.
mp mf
Allegretto
322
mp mf
p mp
p mp
mp mf mp mf
330
mp mf mp mf
p mp p mp
p mp mf
mp mf
338
mp mf
p p mp
p mp
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
&b
U U
U U
&b
U U U U
Bb ∑ ∑ ∑
?
b∑ ∑ ∑
&b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
Bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
w w w w ww
w ww w w
w
w ww w w
w w w w w w
w w w w w w
w w w w w
˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œ œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
15
73
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mp mf mp
346
mp mf
mf
p mp mf
p f
354
p f
p mf
p mf
mp f
362
mp f
p mf
p mf
mp mf
370
mp mf
p mf
p mf
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœ œ œ œ œ
œœ œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
æææ
˙ ™
æææ
˙ ™
æææ
˙ ™
æææ
˙
æææœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ
˙ ™
æææ
˙ ™
æææ
˙ ™
æææ
˙
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙
æææœ
˙ ™ ˙ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œ œœ
œ œ œ œ œœ
œ œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
16
74
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mp mf
378
mp mf
p mp
p mp
mf
386
mf
mf
p
mf
394
p mf
p mp
p mp
mf
402
mf
mf
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
&b
&b
Bb
?
b
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙ ™ œ œœ œ œ
œ
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™
æææ˙ ™ ˙
œ ˙ ™ œ œœ œ œ
œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œ œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
˙œ ˙ ™ œ œ
œ œ œœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙œ ˙ ™ œ œ
œ œ œœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœ œ œ œ œ
œœ œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙œ ˙ ™ œ œ
œ œ œœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙œ ˙ ™ œ œ
œ œ œœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œ œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
˙œ ˙ ™ œ œ
œ œ œœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙œ ˙ ™ œ œ
œ œ œœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœ œ œ œ œ
œœ œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
17
75
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
p
rit.
410
p
p
p
pp
Lento ma non troppo, flessibile
415
pp
ff
Maestoso
416
ff
ff
ff
pp
Meno mosso
424
pp
pp
pp
4
4
4
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
&b
U
U
&b
UU
Bb
U U
?
b
UU
&b
&b
&b
U ##
&b
U ##
Bb
arco
U##
?
b
arco
U##
&
##
U
bb
bb
&
##
pizz.
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
arco
U
bb
bb
B##
pizz.
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
arco
U
bb
bb
?##
pizz.
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
arco
U
bb
bb
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ
J ‰
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ
j
‰
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ
J
‰
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ
œ œ
J ‰
w ww w w
w
w ww
w
w w w w w w
w ww w
w
w
œ
œœ œ
œ
w
w
w
w
w
w
œ
œœ œ
œ ww
ww
w
w
œ
œ œ œœ
ww
ww w
w
œ
œ œ œœ
ww
ww
ww
ww
ww
ww
ww
ww
ww
ww
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙ ™
™ ˙
˙ ™
™
˙
˙
™™
˙
˙
™™
˙
˙
™™
˙
˙
™™
˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
18
76
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
pp
Lento Flessibile
433
pp
pp
Moderato
434
p
mf
p
438
p mf p mf p
pp
442
mf p mf p mf
pp
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&bb
bb
U UU
U
III
&bb
bb
U U U
Bbb
bb ∑
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
3 3 3 3
?
bb
bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
3 3 3 3
?
bb
bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
3 3 3 3
?
bb
bb
pizz.
∑
w
w ww
ww w
w ww
w w
wn
∑
w w w
w ww w w w w
W
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙™™
œ
œ™™
œœ
˙˙™™
œœ
œ
œ
˙
˙™™
œ
œœœ™™
ww
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
19
77
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mf pp mf pp mf pp
446
p mf p mf
mf p mf
mf pp
449
p mf p
p mf p
pp
453
mf p mf
mf p mf
457
mf p mf p
mf p mf p
p
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
&bb
bb
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7 7
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
3 3
?
bb
bb
arco
&bb
bb
. . .
∑ ∑ ∑
. . . .
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
Œ
œœ
œœœ œ œ œ œ œ
Œ
œœ
œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
Œ
œœ
œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w ˙ ™ ˙ w
Œ
œœ
œœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœ œn
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w
w
w
œœœœœœœ
œnœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œbœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœ œn
œœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w
w
www
˙˙™™
˙˙
w
w
œœœœœœœ
œnœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œbœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w w ˙ ™ ˙ w
20
78
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
p mf
461
mf p
mf p
p mf p mf
465
mf p mf p
mf p mf p
p mf
469
mf pmf p
mf p mf p
pp
p mf
473
mf pmf p
mf p mf p
mp
pp
5
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
. . . . . . . .
w
w
œ
œ
˙˙ ™™ ˙
˙ œ œ œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœ œn
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œnœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œbœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
˙˙ œ ˙ œ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ œ œ œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœ œn
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œnœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œbœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
˙ ™ ˙ w w w
˙˙ œ ˙ w
www
œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
˙ ™ ˙ w
w w
˙˙ œ œ w
www
œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w w w
21
79
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
p mf p
477
mf p mf
p
mf p mf
p
mf
p
mf f
481
mf p mf
f
mf p mf
f
mf
f
mp f
485
f
f
mp
f
mp f
489
f
f
mp
f
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
. . . . . . . .
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
. . . . . . . .
˙˙ œ œ œ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ œ œ œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w
˙˙ œ œ œ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ œ œ œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœœ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w
ww w
www
œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w w ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w
ww w
www
œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w w ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w
22
80
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mp f
493
f
f
mp
f
mp
rit.
497
mp
mp
mp
Allegro
501
pp mp
pp
pp
mfmp
507
mf p mf p
mp
pp
6
8
6
8
6
8
6
8
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
. . . . . . . .
&bb
bb
∑
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb ∑
&bb
bb
∑
UU
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
bb
UU
Bbb
bb
UU
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
bb ∑
UU
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
bb
ww w
www
œ ˙˙ ™™
œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w w ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w
ww w
www
œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w w w
‰ ‰
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
j
‰ œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
j ‰
‰ ‰
˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ œ
J
œ œ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
23
81
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mf p mf
512
mf p mf p
p
mp
mp mf
517
mf p mf
pp mp
p mf p
522
p mfp
mp p
p
mf p mf
527
mf
p mf
mp p mp
mp p mp
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb ∑ ∑ ∑
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
> > > > > >> >
Bbb
bb
. . . . . . .
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
> > > > > > > >> >
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
˙ œœ œ
J
œ œ ™ œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œœœœ œ
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œœ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œœ
œœœ œ œ œ
œ
œœ œ œ œ œ œ
r≈ ‰ ‰
œ œ œ œœ œ œ
r≈ ‰ ‰
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
J
œ œ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ œœ œ
J
œ œ ™
œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œ œœœœœœ
œ œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œ œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
r≈ ‰ ‰
œœœœœœœ
r≈ ‰ ‰
œœœœœœœ
r≈ ‰ ‰
œœœœœœœ
r≈ ‰ ‰
œœœœœœœ
r≈ ‰ ‰
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ ™ œœ œ œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœ
œœœ
œœ œœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœ
œ
œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œ
œœœœœœœ
r≈ ‰ ‰
œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ
j
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ
j
˙ ™
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ œ ™ œ œ
J
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ œ
œœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœ
œœœ
œœœ
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ œ ™ œ œ
j
24
82
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
f mp
532
f mp
mf
mf p
mf p
p
rit. Andante
537
p p
p
p
f p
Lentorit.
542
f p
f p
f p
f p f p mf
Allegro
548
mf
p
fmp
mfp
6
8
6
8
6
8
6
8
6
8
6
8
6
8
6
8
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
> > > > >> > > >
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
. . . . . .
&bb
bb
&bb
bb
Bbb
bb
?
bb
bb
&bb
bb
bb
b
U
U
&bb
bb
bb
b
UU
Bbb
bb
bb
b
U
U
?
bb
bb
bb
b
UU
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
> > > > > > > > >
?
bb
b> > > > > >
œ ™ œœ
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
œ œœœœœ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ œ œ
œœœ œœ œ
œœœ œœ œ
œœœ œ œœ
œ œœ œœœ œ
œœ œœœ œ
œœ œœœœ
œœœœœœ
œ ™ œœ
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
œ ™ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œ
œœ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ
J‰
œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœ œn œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœ œn œ
œœœœœœ
œ
œbœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœ œn œ
œœœœœœ
œœ
J
‰
˙ ™˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™˙ ™ œ
J‰
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ
j‰
Œ ™œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ œ
j
œ œ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™
25
83
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
pf p f p
553
mf
f
mf
f p mf p f
558
p mf
mpf
p mf
p f p mf p
563
p mf
p
p f
mp
p mf
p
mf p mf p f
568
mf
mf p f
mf
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
> > > > > > > >
?
bb
b> > > > > >
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
> > > > > > > > >
?
bb
b> > >
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
>> > >
>
>>
>
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
>
>>
>
>> >
> >
?
bb
b
œœœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™
Œ ™œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™
˙ œœ œ
j
œ œ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
Œ ™œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™
œ
J
œ œ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ œœ œ
J
œ œ ™
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œ
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™
˙˙ ™™
Œ ™œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™
œ ™ œœ œ œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ
J
˙ ™
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ
œœœ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œ
œœœ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œ
œ
œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
Œ ™œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™
˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ œ ™ œ œ
J
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œœœœœœ œ
œœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œ
œœœ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
26
84
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
pf p
mf p
573
fp
ff mp
fp
pp pp
rit. Lento Andante
578
pp ppp
pp
pp
586
p
592
pp
pp
2
8
4
4
2
8
4
4
2
8
4
4
2
8
4
4
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
>
>>
> >
>
>>
>
?
bb
b> > >
&bb
b
U
∑
U
&bb
b
U
∑
U
∑
Bbb
b
>
U
∑
U
∑ ∑
?
bb
b
U
∑
U
∑ ∑
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b∑
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
œœœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™ Œ ™
œœ ™™ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœŒ ™
œ ™ œœ
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œœœ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œ œ œœœ œ
œœœœœœ
œ ™ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ ™ œ œ œ
Œ ™œœ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ w
œœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w w w w w w
œœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w w
w ww
w
w ww
w
w
w w w w w
27
85
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
598
pp
604
rit.
610
f p f
Presto
616
f p f
f p f
f p f
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
œœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
ww
w
www
ww
˙˙
˙
˙ww
w w w w w w
Ó
˙ w ˙ ˙
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
˙˙
˙
˙
w
w
˙
˙ ˙˙
w
w
˙
˙ ˙˙ w
w
w w w w w w
w ˙ ˙ w ˙ ˙ w ˙ ˙
˙
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙˙
˙
˙ww
˙˙
˙
˙
w
w
˙
˙ ˙˙
w
w
w w w w w w
w
w
˙
˙
˙
˙
w
w
˙
˙
˙
˙
w
w
w
w
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
ææ
ww
ææ
˙˙
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
ww
ææ
˙˙
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
w
w
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
˙˙
ææ
w
w
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
˙˙
ææ
ww
ææ
˙˙
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
ww
˙
˙ ˙˙
ææw
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
ww
ææ
ww
ææ
ww
ææ
ww
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
28
86
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
mp
628
p
p
p
635
639
643
&bb
b
6 6 6 6
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
6 6 6 66 6 6
6
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
6 6 6 6 6 6 6 6
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
6 6 6 66 6 6
6
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
ææ
˙˙
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
w
w
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
˙˙
ææ
w
w
ææ
˙
˙
ææ
˙˙
œœ
œœœ
œœœ
œœœ
œ œ œœœœ
œœ
œœœœ
œ
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
ææ˙
ææ˙
ææw
ææw
ææ
w
w
ææ
ww
ææ
ww
ææ
ww
ææ
ww
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
wææw
ææw
œœœœœœœœœœœœ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœ œ œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
ææw
ææw
ææw
ææw
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
ææw
ææw
ææw
ææw
œœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœ œ œ
œ
œœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
ææw
ææw
ææw
ææw
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
ææw
ææw
ææw
ææw
œœœœœœœœœœœœ œ œ
œœœœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœ œ œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
ææw
ææw
ææw
ææw
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
ææw
ææw
ææw
ææw
29
87
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
ff mp ff mp ff
647
ff mp ff mp ff
f mp f mp f mp
f mp f mp f mp
mp ff mp ff mp ff mp ff mp ff p
655
mp ff mp ff mp ff mp ff mp ff p
f mp f mp f mp f mp f mp p
f mp f mp f mp f mp f mp p
pp
Meno mosso
666
pp
pp
ppp
670
1
4
4
4
1
4
4
4
1
4
4
4
1
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&bb
b
6 6 6 6
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
U
U
&bb
b
UU
Bbb
b
UU
?
bb
b
UU
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
œœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœ œ œ
œ
œœœœœœ
Ó
˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙
ææw
ææw
Ó ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
ææ
w
wææ
w
wææ
w
wææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææw
ææw
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙
˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ œ
J‰
˙˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙
˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙˙ ˙ ˙ œ
J
‰
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
wææ
w
wææ
w
wææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
œ
œ
J
‰
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
ææ
w
w
œ
œ
j
‰
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
30
88
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
674
678
682
686
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
31
89
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
690
694
696
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
&bb
b
Bbb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
U U
&bb
b
U U
Bbb
b
U U
?
bb
b
U U
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w w w
w w
w w
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
w w
w w w w
w w w w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
w w
w w w w
32
90
Treatment of Rhythmic Material
First Movement
This piece incorporates the use of rhythmic modes as well as cross-rhythms, primarily to
increase the complexity of the texture of the accompaniment. The first movement in particular
relies heavily on this approach. The rhythmic motif, or mode, which underlies most of the
material in the first movement is shown here:
Figure 4.1 Élivágar: Rhythmic Mode
This mode forms the basis of both the nine and four beat patterns which create the following
cross rhythm:
Figure 4.2 Élivágar: Cross rhythm 9:4
The nine beat cycle is later altered so that a triplet falls on the final beat. The ratio 9:4, or 9:8, is
related to the interval of the major second, or major ninth, which is prominent in the thematic
material that opens the movement.
Bar 58 marks a change to a 5/16 metre, with a 3+2 feel. The entry of the viola in bar 90 contrasts
this with phrasing that primarily groups the semiquavers into groups of four, creating another
91
cross rhythm. This time however, the ratio 5:4 does not possess the significance of being related
to the pitch material.
Figure 4.3 Élivágar: Cross rhythm 5:4
The 9:4 ratio returns in bar 185 with a different rhythmic cycle of nine beats.
Figure 4.4 Élivágar: Cross rhythm 9:4 variation
92
Bar 218 introduces a 7/16 metre which forms a cross-rhythm with a 7 against 4 ratio.
Figure 4.5 Élivágar: Cross rhythm 7:4
This 7:4 idea is then augmented so that the units are crotchets rather than semiquavers. Forming
a texture similar to the 9:4 patterns seen earlier. This ratio also foreshadows the prominence of
the minor 7th in the harmonic texture of the final section of the movement.
Figure 4.6 Élivágar: Cross rhythm 7:4 augmentation
The final use of this type of rhythmic texture, although slightly simplified, in the movement
occurs at bar 258. This time the sixteen semiquavers in the bar are grouped differently in the
cello and viola. With the cello playing an asymmetrical pattern: 4+3+3+3+3.
Figure 4.7 Élivágar: Asymmetrical rhythm
This closing passage also uses a simple rhythmic augmentation in the melodic line, which is a
variation of the melodic material from the beginning of the movement.
93
In contrast to the strict metrical techniques discussed so far, stand a number of sections which are
notated without bar lines and often with any indication of rhythm. These sections are essentially
meant to be unmetered and play a significant role in forming a contrast with the rhythmic texture
of the passages analysed above. These sections include the opening of the piece, which contains
some indication of rhythmic values:
Figure 4.8 Élivágar: Unmetred passage
And sections which are notated solely in whole notes where the durations are left entirely to the
performers:
Figure 4.9 Élivágar: Free durations
These sections continue to play an important role throughout the remaining two movements.
94
Second Movement
The second movement eschews the rhythmic complexities of the first. It is for the most part a
simple, European folk music inspired melody in 3/4 time. One feature of note is the
accompaniment at the beginning of the movement.
Figure 4.10 Élivágar: Folk-like violin part with 4:3 pattern in accompaniment
The accompaniment is a four beat pattern, forming the ratio 4:3 with the primary metre, and
echoing the important role of the perfect fourth in the first violin part.
Third Movement
The textures of the third movement are closer to the first. Although it does not continue the
frequent use of cross rhythms that occured in the first movement. One means utilised to enhance
the texture of the accompaniment is the use of polyrhythms which occur in the first part of the
movement without being a prominent feature. The example given below is the most frequently
occurring and once again has a numerical link to the harmonic material. This time the ratio
implied is 16:15, being related to the minor second given that the harmonic material in this
section is moving between C and D-flat. The idea of actually using this ratio strictly, ie. 15 in
the time of 16 in the viola part was considered, but it was dismissed as unnecessary and
excessively difficult.
95
Figure 4.11 Élivágar: Approximate 16:15 polyrhythm
This polyrhythmic texture obtains another layer in passages such as the following in bar 447:
Figure 4.12 Élivágar: Three layered polyrhythm
Bar 503 marks a shift to a 6/8 metre. The texture of this passage includes a flowing melodic line
in the first violin, whilst the second violin has the dual role of playing a fast semiquaver
accompaniment, and doubling the first violin part an octave below by accenting these notes. It is
perhaps worth noting the continued use of textures where the accompaniment is rhythmically
‘energised’ whilst the movement in the melodic line tends to be slow. This is a relic of the style
in which these pieces were originally conceived, in which the drums and the right hand of the
guitarist tend to play fast, whereas the left hand of the guitarist, in other words the melodic and
harmonic material, moves at a slower pace.
96
Figure 4.13 Élivágar: Rhythmically energised accompaniment
This rhythmic ‘energy’ is created in a different way in the climactic final section of the piece,
with the frequent use of tremolo bowing.
Figure 4.14 Élivágar: Tremolo bowing
Before the return of this type of texture shown above, there is one final polyrhythmic passage,
this time a simple 3 against 4, to provide a moment of contrast with the surrounding material.
97
Figure 4.15 Élivágar: Polyrhythm 3:4
Form and Thematic Material
These movements do not follow a rigidly defined formal structure. The first and third
movements in particular have something of the nature of a fantasy about them, with one idea
being presented after another with the connections between them being determined more by their
emotive character rather than by thematic material. A detailed analysis of the internal structures
of all three movements is given here for reference.
First Movement
Bars 1-2: Improvisatory introduction in C minor
Bars 2-4: Violin II establishes ostinato on C and Eb
Bars 5-24: Theme A in viola (c minor), Violin II plays 9 beat rhythmic cycle
Bars 17-24: 9 beat cycle in Violin II creates rhythmic counterpoint with 4 beat pattern in cello
and violin I
Bars 25-26: Cello plays C-Eb pattern unaccompanied in preparation for re-entry of theme A
Bars 27-48: Theme A in violins I and II, separated by two octaves
Bars 27-48: Cello plays variation of 9 beat cycle, ending with a triplet. From bar 35 viola plays
4 beat pattern.
Bars 50-54: Material from bars 1-2 in violins I and II in octaves.
98
Bars 55-57: Material from theme A, in long note durations, unmetred.
Bars 58-172: Material from theme A, new tempo and 5/16 rhythm.
Bar 74: Cello entry
Bar 90: Viola enters with an accompanying figure that creates a 5 against 4 feel.
Bars 122-138: Rhythmic unison.
Bars 138-172: Rhythmic counterpoint in viola.
Bars 173-178: Transitional material moving towards new key (f minor)
Bars 179-184: F minor ostinato established in violin II.
Bars 185-192: Theme B in violin I. 9 against 4 pattern in cello and viola, with new 9 beat cycle.
Bars 193-217: Transitional material returning to C minor.
Bars 201-217: Foreshadowing of melodic material from third movement in violin I.
Bars 218-221: Cello enters in C minor with 7/16 figure.
Bars 221-225: Viola creates rhythmic counterpoint with of 4 against 7 with the cello.
Bars 226-233: Theme B in c minor played by violin I in octaves.
Bars 234-253: Rhythmic and harmonic material from Theme B continues to form climactic
section of movement.
Bars 258-283: Variation on material from Theme A forms coda section of movement.
Second Movement
Bars 284-318: Introductory theme in A major
Bars 319-321: Transitional material in violins, foreshadowing of material from main theme
Bars 322-341: Cello ostinato and main theme in d minor
Bars 342-357: Repeat of theme with viola counterpoint
Bars 358-381: Second theme, tremolo in upper strings
Bars 382-414: Main theme played twice with counterpoint
Bar 415: Flessibile transitional passage
Bars 416-423: Coda using new material in d minor
Bars 424-432: Introductory theme in D major
99
Third Movement
Bar 433: Flessibile introductory material
Bars 434-441: Ostinato theme with shifting triplet group in viola
Bars 442-445: Pizzicato accompaniment in cello, 15 semiquaver notes in violin I
Bars 446-449: Seven against eight pattern in second half of bars in violin I
Bars 450-477: Theme moving between C minor and D flat major continues with shifting
quintuplet pattern
Bars 478-502: Transitional material modulating to f minor
Bars 503-538: Theme B in f minor with accompanying figure in Violin II
Bars 539-547: Transitional passage moving to C minor
Bars 548-583: Theme B in C minor
Bars 584-665: New theme and variations in C minor
Bars 666-699: Coda
100
Chapter 5: Road to the Heart for Baritone and Cello
This piece also consists of ideas accumulated over a long period of time. It is also of
significance in the context of this project as it is a setting of poetry written by Frithjof Schuon,
whose writings on aesthetics form the foundation of the understanding of how to arrive at an
approach to art and music that is determined by the intellectual principles of the traditionalists.
Thus the piece makes use of several ideas that are directly connected with Schuon’s prose work,
most obviously, that the dimensions of music should remain relatively small. This is achieved
here both through the relatively short duration of the songs (although this idea was taken further
in The Lights of Ibrahim ), and also with the minimalistic accompaniment, which consists only of
solo cello. The significance of the use of the cello is also that it is not limited to the slightly
detuned (from harmonically ‘natural’ tunings) intervals of the piano. The way in which the cello
part is composed is intended to encourage the performer to play harmonically natural intervals,
without placing the burden upon them of trying to determine these for themselves. It is accepted
however that some of the more complex parts for the cello may result in the cello player
reverting to something closer to equal temperament.
This piece brings together two distinct approaches, which are correspond to the songs and the
solo cello interludes between and within them. The songs are based on simple modal melodies
which utilise the natural rhythm of the text. Several of these songs were originally written with
piano accompaniments which contained a variety of harmonies, including extensive use of
chords built from fourths. The harmonic texture for the cello accompaniments has been
simplified, focusing primarily on establishing the tonic note of the mode with embellishments
being derived from the natural harmonics. Occasional harmonic movement in the cello part
underlines moments of musical significance. The solo cello sections of the piece explore the
concept of building modes that extend beyond the octave, by adding additional tetrachords, or in
some cases trichords or hexachords.
101
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
Baritone
Violoncello
Lento flessibile
pp mf pp mf pp
Lento flessibile
mp
2
mf p
7
ffmf dim.
13
With
mp
out- beg gin- ning-
mf
q = 60
22
pp mp dolce mf
q = 60
is the ri ver's- start it flows from the moun tain's- un known- ground
p
31
mp p mp p
4
4
3
2
4
4
3
2
4
4
?∑
Shaykh Isa Nur al-Din Ahmad
Road to the Heart
Thomas Devereux
?
?
?
&
&
?
?
?∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
?∑
?
W
w ww
˙ ˙
w
∑ ˙ ˙w w ˙
w ˙ ˙
w
w
˙ œ œ
w
w
w
˙ œœ
w
w
w
˙ œ œ#
w
w
w
˙# œ œ
w
w
w
w
w
˙ œ œ#
w
w
w# w# w#w# w
w# ˙# ˙#
˙#˙
˙ ˙#
w w w w w w w w w
œ œ œœ
J
œ ™ œ
J ‰ Œ Ó
wn
˙˙
w
˙ ˙
w
w
w
w w w
w
w
w
w
w
w
œ œ œ˙
œœœ œ
˙ ˙ Ó Œ ‰œ
J
œ œœ
œ œ œœœ œ œ
w
w
œœ œ œ
˙
w
w w
OO
O
O
˙
˙
w
w ˙
w
˙
102
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
And
mp
seeks the end less
mf
-
36
mf p mp dolce mf mp
so the wise man's heart the ri ver- flows its end is ne ver- found
43
mp pp
mp
mf
49
f
53
Nei
mf
ther- the moun tain
56
p p mf
Nor
mp
the sea can li mit- the ri ver's- song love flows from God to God
63
mp
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
3
2
4
4
3
2
4
4
3
2
4
4
?∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
?∑ ∑
?
?
pizz.
?
?∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
arco
?∑ ∑
?
‰ œ
j
œ œœ
J
œ ™ œ
J ‰ Œ Œ
w
˙ ˙
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
˙ ™
œ œ˙
w
œœ œ œ
˙
œœ
œ œ˙ ˙ Ó Œ ‰
œ
J
œ œœ
œ œ œœ œ œ
œw
w
w
w ™
˙ ˙˙
w
w
w
w
w w
œ
œœœœ
œ
œ œœ
œ
œ œ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœ
œ
œ œœ
œ
œœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ#
œn
œœ# œœ
œn
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ#œ
œœ
œn
œ# œ œ œ# œ
œ
œ œ#œ#
œ# œ#
œn
œ œ œ#œ#
J
œn ™ œ
œœ# œ œ
œn
œ œnœ
œ
œœ œ
œœ œ
j
‰
œ
œ
œœœ œ œn
œ
œ
‰
œ
œ
j
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
œ œ œœ ˙
œ œ œ œœ œ œ
j ‰ ‰œ
J
œ œœ ™ ‰ ‰ œ
j
œ œœ
œ
œ
j‰ Œ Œ
w
w ˙
w
˙
w
w
w
w™™
w
œœ
œ ˙
2
103
°
¢
Forms have an end yet time less- time
mf
less- is the spi rit-
68
mf
p mfp
mf
p
73
3
2
4
4
3
2
4
4
4
4
6
8
?∑
?
?U
bb
b
œ œ œœ ™ œ
J
œ œœ
J
‰ Ó
œœœ œ
œœ œ œ
œ œ œœ
w
w
w
w
w
w
œ œ˙ ™
w ™
˙ ˙ ˙
w
w
W
w ww
˙ ˙
w
∑ ˙ ˙w w ˙
w ˙ ˙
w
w
w
3
104
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
They
mp
think that out of no thing- God has made the u ni- verse- and
q. = 84
75
mp
q. = 84
that it is His shade less
mf
than re al- i- ty- more than a play
mp
the
82
mf mp
world is real and un real- so to say They
mf
think that out of no thing- God has made
Più mosso
88
mf
mf
Più mosso
the u ni- verse- andthat it is His shade less than re al- i- ty- more than a
95
play
mp
theworld is real and un real- so to say The
mf
hid den- trea sure-
Maestoso
101
mp
mf
Maestoso
6
8
6
8
9
8
6
8
9
8
6
8
9
8
6
8
9
8
6
8
6
8
6
8
?
bb
b∑
Creation
?
bb
b
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
?
bb
b
?
bb
b
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
?
bb
b
?
bb
b
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.->
.-
.-> .-
>
.-
.->
.->
.-
.-> .-
>
.-
.->
.-
> .-
.-
.-
.-
.-
?
bb
b
?
bb
b.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.- .-
.-
.- .-
.-
.- .-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
?
bb
b
?
bb
b.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.->
.-
.-> .->
.-
.->
.->
.-
.-> .-
>
.-
.->
.-
> .-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.-
.- ->
->
->
->
Œ ™ ‰ ‰ œ
jœ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J˙ ™ ˙ œ œ
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™Œ ™
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ‰ œ
j
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™Œ œ
jœ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J˙ ™
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
˙ œ œœ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™Œ ™
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ
˙ ™ œ ™ œ
J
‰ œ
jœ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
˙ ™ œ ™Œ
œ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ œ
œ œ
œ
j
œ
œ
œ
œ
j
4
105
°
¢
ne ver- had been shown God
mf
made the world He wan ted- to be known
f
108
mp
mf
f
?
bb
b
U
b
?
bb
b
->
->
->
->
U
b
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
˙ ™
Œ ™
œ ™ œ œ
J
œœ
J
œ œ
J
œ œ
J
˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
œ
œ
œ
j
œ
œ
œ
œ
jœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ œ
œ
j
œ
œœ
œ
J
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
œ
œ œ
œ
j
˙
˙
™™
˙
˙
™™
5
106
p
Lento flessibile
115
mp mf p
mp
p
mf
Misterioso q = c. 90
116
mp mp
espress.
f p mf
mf
123
p
mp p
130
mf f p fmf
Più mosso
137
p mf
mff
rit.
144
p
ff
Lento flessibile Presto
153
dim.156
rit.
mp p
Lento flessibile
160
4
4
4
4
4
4
?
b
Creation II
?
b
pizz.
5
arco pizz.
5
arco
3
3
7
?
b
3 3
53
?
b
pizz.
5
arco pizz.
5
arco
3
3
?
b
.>3
3
?
b
U U3
3
?
b
sul tasto
arco
UU
.>3 3 3 3 3 3
3 3
?
b
.>
.>
.>
.>3 3
3
3
3 3 3 3
?
b bb
b
3
w ww w ww
ww w w
w wwww ww w ww w
w
w
w ww w ww w
w w
œ
J
‰œ
J‰œœœœ
J
‰
œ
j ‰ Œ
‚
J‰ ‰
‚
J‰
œ œ œœœŒ
œ
j ‰ Œ
‚
J‰ ‰
‚
J‰ œœ
œœœœœÓ
Ó
œ œœ œ œ œ œ
j ‰ Œ Óœ œ
˙ w ˙ œ
J ˙ w œ
J
‰œ
J‰œ œ œ œ
J
‰
œ
j ‰ Œ
‚
J‰ ‰
‚
J‰
œ œ œ œ œŒ
œ
j ‰ Œ
‚
J‰ ‰
‚
J‰
w
˙
w
œ œ œ œ w
w w
œ œœœ œ
œœ œ
w
œ œœ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ
œ œn œ œn œ˙ ™
œ
œŒ Ó œ œ œœœ œ
w
w
w
œn œ œ œ œ œ w
w w
œ œ œ œ œ œ w
w
w
w
œ
œ
n œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙
w
w
w
w
œ œ# œ œ œœ
œ œ œ œ œ œœ
œ œ ™œn
J
œ œœœœ
œœœ
œnœœœ
˙
˙
˙
œ œ# œ œ œ œ œ
J‰
œ
j ‰
œ œn œ œ œ œ œ
J ‰
œ
j ‰ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
J
‰
œ
j ‰
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
j ‰ Œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
j ‰ Œ
œ œœ ˙ ™ ˙ ˙ w
w
w w ww w ww
ww w
6
107
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
There
mp
is one word it is the sav ing- key Dwell
p
thou in
q = c. 72
164
p pp p pp p
q = c. 72
God and God will dwell in thee out
pp
of com
p
pas- - sion to our
173
pp p pp pp
world he came
mf
His
p
are two homes on earth our
mf
heart His Name
180
p pp p pp p
4
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
?
bb
b
One Word
?
bb
b∑
&
?
bb
b
&bb
b?
?
bb
b
U
?
bb
b
U
œ
˙
Ó
˙ ™ œ œ ˙
Œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙
Œœ
˙
Ó
˙ ™ œ œ
w
w
w
w
~ ~
w
w
~
w
w
w
w
˙
Œœ œ
œ œœ w ˙
Ó
œœ œ
œ ˙
Œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
~ ~w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
~
œ œ ˙ ˙
Œœ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œŒ
˙ ˙w w w
w
w
~
w
w
w
w
~ ~ ~
w
w
7
108
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
She
p
she
mp
my be lov- ed- is a won drous- day
q = 80
188
p mp pp p
pp
q = 80
And
mp
I I who love Her I am life
f
life
197
mp pp mp pp
mf
pp f
mf
and death and death
p
And
mf
storm and light ning and
207
p pp mf
light ning-
f
and
mf
my word is wine is wine
mp
the world
216
pp mp
pp mp pp
lies in my blood my
pp
blood and in my
mf
breath
p
225
mp pp
mp
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
?
bb
b
Confession
?
bb
b &
?
&
?
bb
b
&bb
b?
&
4:3
?
&
?
&
4:3
?
?
bb
b
?
bb
b &
?
&
?
?
bb
b
U
?
bb
b &
?
&
3:2
?
&
3:2
?
?
bb
b
?
bb
b &
4:3 3:2
3:2
3:2
?
pizz.
3
˙ ™ ˙Œ
˙ ™ ˙Œ œ œ œ œ ˙
Ó
œ œœ
œ˙ ™
˙ ™
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙̇™™ ˙̇
™™ ~
~n
n
w
œœ
œœ
œœ œ
œ˙˙™™
˙˙
‚
‚n
n
˙œ ˙ ™ ˙
Œ˙ ™ ˙
œœ ˙
Œœ
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
‚
‚
‚n
‚n
‚O
On
n ˙
‚
‚
n
n
‚
‚
‚
‚
‚ ˙
‚
‚
#
n
‚
‚
‚n
‚n
˙n
‚
‚
‚
‚
‚
‚
‚˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ ™™
˙œ
˙ ™ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙œ ˙ ™ ˙ œ
œ ˙ ˙ œ
˙˙ ™™
˙˙ ™™
˙˙™™
˙˙™™
œ
œ
‚
‚ ‚
‚n
n œ
œ œœœœ
œ
œœnœœnœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ
œ
œœœœ
œ ˙ ˙ œ œœ
œ ˙ ™ ˙œ
˙ ™ ˙œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œ
œ
œœœœ
O
O
n
n
œœ
œœbb
œœ œ
œ˙˙ ™™
˙˙™™
˙˙
‚
‚n
n ‚
‚n
n
‚
‚n
n
‚n
‚
˙ ‚
‚n
n ‚
‚
n ‚
‚
n
‚n
‚n
œ œœ
œ˙ ™ ˙ œ ˙b œ ˙ œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
œœbb
œœ
œœ œ
œ˙˙
‚
‚n
n ‚
‚n
n
‚n
‚n
‚
‚
‚n
n ‚
‚
n
‚n
‚
‚
‚n
‚
‚n
‚
‚
‚
‚n
n ‚
‚
‚#
‚
˙n ™ œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
8
109
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
O thou thou
mp
who seek est-
233
medo
ne ver- ask which
mf
is my home land
239
mf
nor what is my name
p
The
p
u ni- verse-
245
p
is made of light and love
f
and from this light
252
f pp mp pp
and from this love
ff
I came
259
f mp
mp
5
4
3
4
5
4
5
4
3
4
5
4
5
4
3
4
5
4
3
4
2
4
3
4
2
4
3
4
?
bb
b
?
bb
b
3 3 3
3
3
3
?
bb
b∑
?
bb
b
3
3 3
?
bb
b∑
?
bb
b
arco
3
?
bb
b
?
bb
b &
?
&
?
&
?
3
3
3
?
bb
b
?
bb
b &
?
3 3
˙ ™ Ó œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œœ œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œn
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
˙ ™ ˙ œ œ œ˙ ™
œ œœ
œ ˙
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œn
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœœ
œ
˙œ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ Ó œ
œ œ œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœ œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœœ
œ
œ œœœœ
œ
œ œœœœ
Ó œœ œ œ
œ œ œœ œ
˙ ™ ˙ œ œ œ œ
œ
œœnœœnœ
œ
œœœœœ
œœœ
œœœœ
œnœnœ
œœœb
˙
‚
‚n
n ‚
‚n
n
O
On
n œ
‚
‚#
#
‚n
‚
‚
œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙
œ˙ ™
œn
‚
‚
‚n
‚n ‚n
‚n
‚#
‚
‚
‚
‚
‚n
‚n
‚#
‚
‚
‚
‚
˙n ™
9
110
°
¢
I came
p
263
pp
?
bb
b
?
bb
b &
?
3
˙ œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
˙ ™‚n
‚n‚n
‚
‚
‚‚ ‚n
‚n‚n
˙ ™ ˙ ™
10
111
p
Lento flessibile
268
mf p
rit.
pp
Maestoso
269
pp
Misterioso q = c. 60
276
rit.
279
p mf mp p
Più mosso flessibile
281
pp
284
rit.
mf p mf
Più mosso
287
p pp
293
rit.
297
f
ff
Allegro
300
4
4
4
4
5
4
6
4
5
4
4
4
15
16
4
4
15
16
15
16
4
4
4
4
15
16
4
4
15
16
15
16
4
4
15
16
15
16
4
4
15
16
4
4
4
4
?
bb
b
Confession II
?
bb
b
u
U
?
bb
b
.>
.......
.>
.......
.>
. ......
.>
. .....
.>
.......
.>
.......
?
bb
b
.>
. ..
..
..
.>
. ..
..
.
U
?
bb
b
sul tasto
U U
?
bb
b
.>
.......
.>
.......
.>
. ......
.>
. .....
.>
.......
.>
.......
?
bb
b
.>
. ......
.>
. .....
U
?
bb
b
U
.>
.......
.>
.......
?
bb
b
.>
. ......
.>
. .....
.>
.......
.>
.......
.>
. ......
.>
. .....
?
bb
b
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
W
w wW
w wn
W
˙ ˙w
W w w
W W
w
œœ œn œ
œ
œ
w
œœ œn
œ
˙
˙
w
œœ œn œ
œ
œ
w
œœ œn
œ
w
˙˙n
w
˙# ˙
w
w
œ
œnœ#œnœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œ#
œ# œ#œ#œœœœ
œ
œ œœœœœ
œn
œnœ#œnœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œ#
œ# œ#œ#
œœ
œœ
œ
œ œœ
œœ
œ
w
wn
b
œb œb œb œb œb œœ œ œb œb œ œ œ œ œb œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
w
wn
w
wb
œ
œnœ#œnœœœœ
œn
œœœœœœœ
œ#
œ# œ#œ#œœœœ
œ
œ œœœœœ
œn
œnœ#œnœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œ#
œ# œ#œ#œœœœ
œ
œ œœœœœ
œ
œn
n œ
œn
œ
œn
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
œ
œ
˙˙# ˙
˙ww#
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
œ
œ
˙˙# ˙
˙ww#
œ
œnœ#œnœœœœ
œn
œœœœœœœ
œ#
œ# œ#œ#œœœœ
œ
œ œœœœœ
œn
œnœ#œnœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœœ
œ#
œ# œ#œ#œœœœ
œ
œ œœœœœ
œn
j
œ
œn
nœ
œn
n œ
œn
n œ
œ
œ
j
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
nœ
œ
œ
j
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
n œ
œ
œ
j
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
nœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
n
b œb œb œb œb œ
œ
œ
œ œ œb œb
11
112
p
306
ff
mp p
cresc.
312
318
f ff mf ff p
320
2
4
4
4
4
4
2
4
4
4
4
4
?
bb
b
∏∏∏∏∏∏∏
∏∏∏∏
∏∏∏∏
nU
u
u
Upizz.
?
bb
b
arco
.>.> .> .>
.>
.> .>.>
.>.> .> .>
.>
.> .>.>
?
bb
b
?
bb
b
.>
.>
U
bb
b
œ
œ
œ
b œ œb œœ
œ
œb œ œœ
œ
œ œb œ œ œ œ w
˙
˙ w
wb œœ œn œ
œœ œ œ
œœ œn œ
œœ œ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
n œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œn
n œ
œ
w
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙˙n ˙
˙
#
˙
˙
æææw œ œ
œn œ#œ œ
œœœœœœ
œb œ œb œ
œb œb œb œb
œ œn œn œ#œ œ œ œn œ œ œ œ
œb œ œb œ œ œb œb œb
w
w
<b> w
w
n
œ#
j
w
wæææ˙#
œ
œ
Œ
œ
œ
Œ
w
12
113
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
O
p
Thou Thou
cresc.
whose Name is Name
mf
is sweet
mp
est-
q = c. 72
326
p pp
q = c. 72
sweet
p
est- re me- dy- And
mp
whose re mem- brance-
334
p
heals
mf
our soul's dis ease- With
mp
thee With thee each mo
p
ment-
343
pp
mo ment- mo ment- each
mp
mo ment- is E ter- ni- ty-
mf
a
pp
drop from Hea -
352
pp
ven
mp
Hea ven
mf
- That con soles- and frees That con soles- and frees a
p
360
mp
4
4
4
4
?
bb
b
Remembrance
?
bb
b &
?
bb
b
&bb
b
”“
?
?
bb
b
U
?
bb
b
?
bb
b
U U
nn
n
?
bb
b nn
n
?
?
Ó Œ œ w œ Œ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ Ó˙ ˙ ˙ Ó œ œ œ
˙
w w
O
O
w
~
w
O
O
w
~
w
O
O
w
~
~
˙Ó œ œ œ
˙ ˙Ó ˙ ˙ w ˙ Œ œ
˙ ™ œ ˙ œ œ ˙ ™Œ
~
~ ~~ ~
w w
O
O
w
~
w
O
O
˙ ˙ ˙ œœ w ˙
Ó˙ œ œ ˙ Ó
˙ œ œ ˙ Œœ
œ œ œ Ó
w
~
w
O
O
w
~
w w
O
O
w
~
w
O
O
w
~
œ
‚
Œ Ó
œœœ Ó œ
œœ Œ
œœ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ w w ˙ Œ
œ œ œ œœ
œ
‚
Œ Ó
œ
‚
Œ Ó
w w
O
O
w
~
w w w
˙ ™ Œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ™ Œ˙ ˙ ˙
˙˙ ™ Œ
˙ ˙ ˙˙
˙ Œ
œ
w w w w w w w w w
13
114
°
¢
°
¢
drop from Hea ven- Hea ven- - that con - -
369
p
soles
ff
and
mp
frees
374
f p
?
?
?
U
bb
?U
bb
œ œ œœ ˙ ™ Œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙ ˙
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
˙ ˙ w ˙ ™
Œ w w w
w
w
w
w
˙
˙
™
™ Œ
w w w
14
115
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
I
p
love be cause- I love this word is more than just a fee ling it is wis dom's- core love
q = c. 72
380
p
q = c. 72
God with out- con di- tions- love God the most high
mf
will love thee too
p
385
mf p
and will not ask thee why
pp
388
pp
4
4
5
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
6
4
6
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
?
bb
3
The Core
?
bb
3
?
bb
?
bb
?
bb
bb
b
3
?
bb
pizz.
bb
b
3
œ
J
œ œ œ œ œ ™ œ
J
œœ
˙ œœ œ œ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ™œ
œ
J
w
œ œ œ œ œ ™
w
œ
j
œ œ ˙
˙ ™
œ œ œ œ œœ œ
˙ w
œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ™œ œ
œ ™ œœ
œ œ
œ œœ
œ ™œ
J
œ œ œ ™ œ
J
œœ
œ
w ™
œ ™ œ œœ œ
œ œ
w
œ œ œ ™ œ
j œ œ
w
œ ™ œ
j
œ œ œ
œ ™ œ
J
œ œ œ œ œ œ
Œ Ó˙
Ó
w
œ ™ œ
j
œ œ
œ
œ œ œ œŒ Ó
œ
œ Œ Ó
15
116
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
Say
mp
yes say yes
Moderato flessibile
391
mp
Moderato flessibile
to
p
God God will say yes
392
pp
to
mf
thee
394
mp pp
To
mp
Hea ven's- - gate this
p
is the gol den- key
397
p
398
pp
3
4
3
4
?
bb
b
The Road
?
bb
b &
?
bb
bÚ
&bb
b
U U U
∑
?
bb
b
U U U
?
bb
bÚ
U U
Ú
&bb
b
U U
Ú
U U U?
?
bb
b
U U U U U
?
bb
b
?
bb
b
&bb
b
U U U U
?
bb
b
U U U U
∑ œ
˙Œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ wn
W
œ ˙b Œ œ œ œn œ œ œ œ ˙b w
∑
~∑
w
wn
wb w
w
W
w wn
∑
~ ~∑ ∑
w
wn
wb W wb w
wn
w
œ
˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ
J
œ ™ ˙n Œ œ ˙b Œ œ
œb
j
œ œ œ œ œ œ œb w
W
∑
~∑ ∑
w
wn
wb w
w
w
16
117
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
a
mp
bout- my earth ly- road I do not care
h. = c. 50
399
p mp p
h. = c. 50
it
mp
may be long
Moderato flessibile
409
Moderato flessibile
pp
p
short
p
is God's road to me
411
pp
413
mp
cresc.
f
414
p
molto espress. flessibile
mf f mp
rit.
pp
415
3
4
3
4
?
bb
b∑ ∑ ∑
?
bb
b
pizz.
?
bb
bÚ
&bb
b
arco
U U
∑
?
bb
b
U U U
?
bb
bÚ
3
&bb
b
U U
∑
?
bb
b
U U
&bb
b
U U U U
?
bb
b
U U U U
?
bb
b
U UU
U U U
?
bb
b
molto sul tasto
&
√
3 3
Ó œ
˙ œ ˙ œ ˙nœ ˙b
œ ˙n ™ ˙ ™
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ œœ
œ
œ œœ
œ œb
œœb
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œb
œœb
œ
Œ Œ
œ œb œnœ
j
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w
∑
~∑
w
wn
wb w
w
W
œ œb œn œ œ œ œ œ ˙œ œ œ œ œ w
∑
~
w
wn
wb W
∑
~∑
~
w
wn
wb w
w
w
ww#
n ww
w
wn w
wnww w
w
wœb
j
wœ
j
œ œœn œw
œ
j
œœ œ œœœ
œœœœœœœ œ wb
œ œ
œ
j
œ œœœ
œ
jœœ œ œ œ œ ˙ ™
~~n
17
118
Treatment of Form and Thematic Material
The internal structure of the songs does not require a great deal of analysis. Provided here is
simply an overview of the placement of songs and cello interludes.
1. The River (Song) - Includes three solo cello sections not given the status of individual
movements. At the beginning, between the two verses, and at the end.
2. Creation (Song)
3. Creation II (Interlude)
4. One Word (Song)
5. Confession (Song)
6. Confession II (Interlude)
7. Remembrance (Song)
8. The Core (Song)
9. The Road (Song) - This final song also concludes with a relatively lengthy solo cello
passage.
As for the internal structure of the songs, for the most part they follow one of two schemes, the
shorter songs consist of a single verse. The longer songs usually consists of one verse, followed
by another in which the character of the song changes to accomodate the text. The song ‘One
Word’ is an example of the first type, whereas ‘Remembrance’ demonstrates the latter approach.
In this case, the change in the character of the song, occurs at bar 359 and only for the final line
of the text, which is repeated several times to extend this passage and underline its poetic
significance.
119
Treatment of Pitch/Rhythmic Material
The treatment of pitch material is relatively straightforward in the songs, which mostly utilise
melodies in the minor mode occasionally shifting to the major with a bare minimum of harmony
provided by the cello. Ventures into other modes are found in ‘The River’ which uses a major
pentatonic, and ‘The Road’, which uses a synthetic mode best described as a phrygian mode with
a raised third. The cello part is more adventurous, particularly in the solo cello sections. During
the songs the cello is mostly confined to establishing the tonic note of the mode and providing
ornamentation with harmonics, these are considerably more adventurous in the song
‘Confession’ than elsewhere, and the cello has a more rhythmically intricate part here as well.
The more complex character of the solo cello sections is evident from the very beginning of the
piece, where the cello uses essentially three major pentatonic modes, one in C (red), one in A
(blue), and one in F# (green).
Figure 5.1 Road to the Heart: Pentatonic modes
120
The solo cello parts also utilise rhythmic layers. In the example below, which uses the same
modal structure as the one shown above, the low C in the cello recurs after every three quavers,
establishing a secondary rhythmic layer in addition to the primary 4/4 metre.
Figure 5.2 Road to the Heart: Rhythmic layers
The first cello interlude, ‘Creation II’, uses a similar modal technique to the sections from ‘The
River’ shown above, although this time it is built from a minor tetrachord instead of fragments of
the pentatonic scale. The full mode is shown below.
Figure 5.3 Road to the Heart: Non-octave mode
The final cello interlude, ‘Confession II’ uses the mode of the greatest complexity.
Figure 5.4 Road to the Heart: Non-octave mode
121
Although not conceived of in this way, this mode can be analysed as a Lydian tetrachord on C,
followed by a Phrygian, or Aeolian, tetrachord on G, and finally an Aeolian tetrachord on D-flat.
This mode is the best example of this approach to creating modes that extend beyond the octave
on display in this piece.
Another feature of the cello accompaniment occurs in the penultimate song, ‘The Core’, where
the cello, in addition to the drone, accompanies the voice with a harmonisation that is
deliberately reminiscent of organum. The term ‘1st species counterpoint’ is used to designate the
note-against-note texture, although the intervallic relationships between the voices are derived
from organum and therefore contain parallel perfect consonances. In the song this appears thus:
Figure 5.5 Road to the Heart: Organum style 1st species counterpoint
To make this clear one can reduce this material to the two melodic lines:
Figure 5.6 Road to the Heart: Analysis of counterpoint
122
Chapter 6: Songs of Sorrow and Light for Tenor and Piano
This piece is a setting of texts written by the composer. Once again these are in the form of
miniatures. This piece mostly uses techniques already discussed, although it uses a different
kind of piano writing than The Lights of Ibrahim as well as some rudimentary functional
harmonies. In accordance with the considerations related to tuning made in chapter 2, the piano
accompaniment could be replaced with another instrument with less restrictions on its intonation.
123
{
{
{
{
{
Tenor
Piano
Andante con rubato q = c. 96
pp p
°
poco più mosso
pp
7
Win
mp
ter- came soon er- than ex pec
mf
- ted- fro
mp
zen- leaves
15
pp
lay life less- on the for
mf
est- floor
p
the
23
sky
mf
a bove- a black ened- void in
p
fin- ite-
29
mppp
4
4
4
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
I
Songs of Sorrow and Light
Thomas Devereux
&bb
b
U UU
”“
?
bb
b∑
&
?
&
&bb
b
U U
“: ;ÿ◊
&bb
b?
&
U?
U
&
”“
?
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
>>
> >>
>
”“
3
3
œœœœ œ
œœœ
?
bb
b &
?
&
?
7
7
3
3
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑
&bb
b
”“
œœœ
œ œœœœ
œœœœ
?
bb
b &
?
7 7
7
œ
œœ
œ
œœ œ
œœ
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
>>
>
”“
>>
>
”“
œœœ
œ œœœœ
œœœœ
?
bb
b &
>>
>
?
&
>>
>
7 7
7
œ
œœ
œ
œœ œ
œœ
ww
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
www
w
ww
wœ
œœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœ
œ
ww
w
w
w
w
w
w
ww
w
œœœ
œœœœœ
œœœœ
œœ
œœ
œœœ
œ œœœœ
˙ ˙www
ww
w
n#
w
ww
n
n
www
#
wwwbn
www
w
w
w
w
ww
w
ww
w
˙
˙
˙
˙wwwn
#www#
#w
wwn
#
nwww#
n w
wn
#
œ œœ
œ
œŒ Œ
œ œ
œœ
Œœ œ
œœ
˙˙ ™™
˙˙
œ ™œ
J
œ
˙ ˙ œœ
œ
œœ
œ ˙œ
œ
œ
œ˙
˙
ww
˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙ Ó
˙
˙
™
™
Œœœ
œœœ
œ
Œ
˙
˙
˙
˙
™
™
w
w
œŒ Ó
œ œ œ œœ
œ
œŒ Ó Œ
œ
˙˙
Œ
œœ
œ
˙
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
Œ
˙
˙ Œ Ó
w wœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ œœ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
Ó
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œœœ
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™
Œ Œ
œœœ
œ ˙ ™
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
Ó
œœœ
œ
˙
˙
™
™
˙
˙
™
™
Œ
œœ
œ ˙ ™
124
{
{
{
{
{
{
though it can not-
36
con
mf
tain- my
mp
sor row-
40
p
46
mf
mf p
pp
51
a
p
drop let- fell u pon- the o
mf
cean- floor
mp
swal lowed- by the a -
q = 72 e=e58
byss it cried out
mf
I am no thing- but my long ing- for you
63
mf
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
8
4
4
5
8
4
4
5
8
4
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
U UU
∑
”“
3
3
3
3
œ
œœ
&bb
b ∑?
3
3
3
3
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b ∑
>>
>
”“
3
3
3
3
”“
œ
œœ
?
bb
b &
>>
>
3
3
3
3
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
“: ;
&bb
b
&bb
b
“: ;
&bb
b
&
‹
bb
b
II
&bb
b
“: ;
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&
‹
bb
b ∑
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑?
U
&
&bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑?
U
œ œ œ œ
ww
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
w
www
w
ww
wÓ
œ
œœœ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ w
w
w œ
œœœ
œœ
œ
œœ
Ó
w
w
œ œ
œŒ Ó Œ œ
œ
œÓ
Ó
œ
œœœ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ œ
œœ
˙ wœœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœ
w
w œ
œœœ
œœ
œ
œœ
Ó Œ
œœ
˙ w
w
ww
w
ww
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œœœ
œœœœœœœœ
œœœœœœœœ œ
œ˙ ™ w w w
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
w˙
˙
w
Ó Œ ‰ œ
J
œœ
˙‰
œ
j
œ œ
˙ œœ
˙Ó
œ œ œœ
œ
w
w
˙Œ ‰
œ
j
œ
œ ˙
Œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œœ ˙
Ó
Ó˙˙˙
www
Ó
˙
˙
w
w
2
125
{
{
{
{
{
like
mp
the song of the whis pering- breeze your
mf
love
mp
rea
mf
ches- in to- ev ery- place in
p
-
68
pp
mf p
to the blood that flows in my veins
mf
and will re main- when
p
the world is naught but ash
mf
es
mp
-
74
mf p
mf p
stretched
p
and bro ken- he
q = 96
81
p pp
cried
mf
out
p
his voice ech oed-
89
through the dark
mf
ness- re
mp
tur- ning- to himit
96
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&
‹
bb
b ∑
III
&bb
b
?
bb
b &∑
?
&
&
‹
bb
b ∑
U
&bb
b
U
?
U
&bb
b?
U
U
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
IV
?
bb
b &
”“
∑ ∑
3
3
3
3
3
”“
?
bb
b &∑
?∑
&
3
3 3
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑
&bb
b
“: ;
?
&∑
3
3
3
3
3
”“
&bb
b
”“
?
&
3
3 3
&
‹
bb
b
&bb
b
“: ;
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
&bb
b
”“
?
&
∑ œœ œ œ œ
œ œœ ™
œ
J
œ
J œ ™ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ˙
Œ ‰ œ
J
Œ
œœ œ
œœ œ
œ ˙ ™
Œ œœ œ œ œ
œ œœ
œœ œ
œœ ™™
œ
J
œ œ œ œ œ
œœ
œœ œ
œœ œ
œœ œ w
Œ œœ ˙ w
w
œ
œ œœ ˙
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ˙
Ó Œ ‰
œ
J
œ
œ ˙œ œ œ œ œ œ
˙˙
œ
œœ œ œ œ
œ
ww
‰
œ
J
œ œ œ œ œ
œ
œ
œ
™™
œ
J
œ œ œ œ œ œ˙
˙ ™™ ˙
˙
˙˙˙
w ˙
˙
˙
˙
˙
˙
™
™
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ˙ ™
œ
œœ œ œ
œœ ˙
˙
˙
œ œœ œ
œ
Œ Œ
œ œ
œ œœ œ
Ó
œ œœ œ
œ œœ œ w w
‰œœœ
œœœœœ
œ
œœœœœ
œ œœ œ
˙
˙œ œ
œ œ∑
w
w
Ó
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
‰ Œ Œ Œ
œ œ
œ œ
˙ œ˙ ™ œ ˙
Ó œ œœ œ
œ
Œ
˙ ™ ˙œ œ
œ œ ˙œ œ
œ œ w ‰œ œ
œ
œ œœœ œ
œ
œ œœœ œ
œ œœ œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ œ œœ œ ˙
œ œœ œ ˙
w
w
Ó
œœœœœ
œ
œœœ
‰ Œ Œ Œ
œ œ
œ œ
Œ
œ œ
˙ œ œ Œ Œ Óœ œ œ
œœ
œŒ Ó Ó
œ œ
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ œœœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ œ œ
œœœœ
œœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ œ œœ œ œ ˙ ™
˙
˙
™
™ ˙˙
˙
˙˙
˙
3
126
{
{
{
{
spoke
mf
"am
p
I not your sa
mf
viour?"-
103
mf pp p
109
113
poco più mosso
ppmf
q = 96
118
16
16
16
16
16
16
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
”“
3 3 3 3
&bb
b?
∑ ∑
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
?
bb
b∑ ∑
&
‹
bb
b ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&bb
b
√
>
U
?
bb
b
√U
‘“
&
&bb
b
ÿ◊U U U
U
&bb
b
”“?
∑&
U U
˙
Óœ œ œ œ
œ ˙Œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœ w
Ó
œœœ œ
œœœ œ w
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙
˙
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
˙ ™
˙ ™
w
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœn
œ
Ó
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œœ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œœ
œ œ
œ
Ó
wwwb
ww
w
n#
w
ww
n
n
www
#
wwwbn
ww
w
w
n w
w
w
w
b w
w
b w
www
ww
ww
ww
ww
w
w
wwwn
#www#
#w
wwn
#
nwww#
n w
wn
#∑ ∑
w
w
w
w
w
w
ww
4
127
{
{
{
{
like
mf
the light of the brea king- dawn your pre sence- is my be gin- ning- and my
q = 72
121
mf p
cresc.
end be fore- now I was not
f124
mf
f
nor
p
will I e ver- be a gain
f
-
127
mp
p
130
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
5
4
4
4
&
‹
bb
b
V
&bb
b
”“
”“
7 7
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
&bb
b? ?
7
7
œ
œœ
&
‹
bb
b
&bb
b
>>”“
7 7
7 7
”“
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
œœœœ
?
bb
b
?∑
? ?
7
7
7
7
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
&
‹
bb
b ∑
&bb
b
“: ;
?
&
?
?
bb
b∑
?
&
?
3 3
?
bb
b &
?
&
U
?
bb
b &
?
&
?
U3 3
œœ œ œ œ
œ œœ ™
œ
J
œ
J œ ™ œ
œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ
Œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J
œ
œ ™
™
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
Œ
œ
œ
œ
œ œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
œ
J œ
œ
™
™
œ
œœœœœœ
˙ Ó œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙
Ó
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œœ
˙
œ
œœ
œ
œœ
œ
œœœœœœ
œ
œœœœœœ
‰
œ œ œ œ œ œ
œ˙
Ó
œœ
˙ ™
Œ
œœ
œœŒ
œœœœ
œœœœ
Œ
œœœœŒ
œ
œœ
Œ
œœœœ Œ Œ
œœœœ
Œ
œœ
œ
Œ
œœ
œœ
Œœ
œœ
œœ
œœ
œ
Œ
œœ
œœ
Œ Ó
˙˙˙˙
wwww
œ
œœ
Œ
œœ
œœ Œ Œ
œœ
œœ
Œ
œœ
œ
˙
˙
˙˙
w
w
5
128
Analysis
The opening section introduces one of the key themes of the piece in C minor. It is heard twice,
the second time including broken chords in the right hand of the piano.
Figure 6.1 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Theme
Also note the conclusion of this section with a highly chromatic progression in bar 14. This
progression is used to denote structurally significant moments in the piece. 97
The entry of the voice immediately introduces two of the three key motivic ideas in the piece,
motifs A (red) and B (blue).
Figure 6.2 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motifs A & B
97 This is another example of a case where a musical language that is generally rejected in this project is used in a limited fashion and for a specific purpose.
129
These two motifs form the basis of the melodic material in the first, second, and fourth
movements. Of particular significance are the final three notes of motif A, which are echoed in
the piano part throughout the remainder of the first movement. The following examples, from
the second and fourth movements respectively show a number of variations on motifs A and B.
Figure 6.3 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motivic analysis
Figure 6.4 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motivic analysis
130
The third movement, in E-flat major, introduces the third key motivic idea (C - green), which
forms the basis of both the melody and the piano accompaniment.
Figure 6.5 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Motif C
The fourth movement returns to the material from the first two movements, the tonal centre is
shifted to G but the key signature remains the same, resulting in a Phrygian mode. The
movement concludes with a recapitulation of the thematic idea from the opening of the piece,
now in G minor, followed by a transitional passage which moves to E-flat major in preparation
for the final movement.
Figure 6.6 Songs of Sorrow and Light: Theme
The final movement is similar to the third, also in E-flat and also being based on motif C. Here
the piano writing is more expansive and a simple IV-V-I progression is used to conclude the
piece.
131
Chapter 7: Salve Regina for SSAATB Choir
This piece is a conventional choral piece in the tradition of sacred choral music, utilising
conventional counterpoint techniques and melodic ideas from plainchant, as well as occasional
extended harmonies. This piece is not intended to have a liturgical function, but was inspired by
certain forms of liturgical vocal music as well as the traditions of Marian spirituality in the
Catholic and Orthodox traditions which retain a personal significance despite the fact that I do
not follow either of these traditions. In this connection the following passage written by Frithjof
Schuon describing the role of the Virgin Mary as a link between Christian and Islamic
spirituality is significant:
“Mother of all the Prophets and matrix of all the sacred forms, she has her place of honor
within Islam even while belonging a priori to Christianity; for this reason she constitutes
a kind of link between these two religions, whose common purpose is universalizing the
monotheism of Israel. The Virgin Mary is not merely the embodiment of a particular
mode of sanctity; she embodies sanctity as such. She is not one particular color or one
particular perfume; she is colorless light and pure air. In her essence she is identified with
merciful Infinitude, which—preceding all forms—overflows upon them all, embraces
them all, and reintegrates them all.” 98
98 Frithjof Schuon, ‘Alternations in Semitic Monotheism,’ Studies in Comparative Religion 11, No. 3, 1977
132
°
¢
°
¢
Solo Alto
Sal
flessibile
ve- re gi- na- ma ter- mis er- i- cor- di- ae- vi ta- dul ce- do- et spes nos tra- sal ve-
q = 72
Sal
p
ve- Re gi- na- ma ter- mis er- i- cor- di- ae- vi
mf
ta- dul ce
p
- do- et
pp
spes nos tra- sal ve-
2
Sal
p
ve-
Ad
mp
te cla
mf
ma- mus- ex su
mp
- les- fi li- i- He
mf
vae
p
-
10
Ad
mp
te sus pir
mf
- a- mus- ge men
mp
- tes- et flen
mf
tes
p
-
Ad
p
te Ad
p
te Ad
mp
te cla
mf
ma- mus- ex su
mp
- les-
mf p
Ad
mp
te sus pi
mf
- ra- mus-
p
Ad
mp
te
mf p
in
mf
hoc la cri- mum- val le-
Sal
p
ve-
6
4
6
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
5
4
&
Salve Regina
Thomas Devereux
&Soprano I
3
&Soprano II
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&Alto I
∑
&Alto II
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&
‹: ;
Tenor
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
?
Bass
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&
@ ?
U
&∑ ∑
@ ?
U
&
U
&∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
U
&
‹: ;
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
U
?U
œœ#
œ œ# ˙ œœ œ# œ œ œ œ ˙
œœ œ ˙
˙ œ œ œœ œ œ w
œœ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ ˙ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ# ™ œ
J
˙ œ ˙ œ œ ˙# ˙ œ œ œ œ œ œ# w
œ ˙ ™ ˙ ˙ œ œ œ œ œ w w ˙ ™ œ œ œ œ ˙ ™
w
œœ œ œ œ œ œ ™ œ
j
˙ ˙ œ ™ œ
J
œ œ w w ˙ ™ ˙ w
œœ œ œ œ œ œ ™ œ
j
˙ ˙ œ ™ œ
J
˙ w ˙ ™ ˙ w
w œœ œ œ
œœ œ œ
œœ œ œ œ œ œ ™ œ
j
˙ ˙ w# ˙ ™ ˙ w
œœ œ œ œ œ ˙ w ˙ ™ œ ™
œ
j
œ œ ˙ ™
œœ œ œ ˙
œœ œ# ™ œ œ œ œ œ œ w
œ ˙ ™ w w w w w
w ˙ ™ ˙
w
133
°
¢
°
¢
°
¢
E
flessibile
ia- er go- ad vo- ca- ta- nos tra- il los- tu os- mis ser- i- cor- des-
19
E
p
ia- Er go- ad
poco rubato
vo ca- ta- nos tra- il los- tu os- mis
mp
er- i- cor- des- o cu- los- ad nos con ver- te-
20
ad
p
poco rubato
vo ca- ta- nos tra- il los- tu os-
pp
ad
p
poco rubato
vo ca- ta- nos tra- il los- tu os-
pp
ad
p
poco rubato
vo ca- ta- nos tra- il los- tu os-
pp
Et
mp
Je sum- Je sum- Je sum
f
-
pp
be
mp
ne- dic- tum-
pp
29
Je
mp
sum- Je sum- Je sum
f
- be
mp
ne- dic- tum-
pp
fruc
mp
tum-
Et
p
Je sum- Je
mf
sum- Je sum
f
-
pp
Je
mf
sum-
f pp
u
pp
u
pp
ven
mp
tris- tu i-
pp
no
mf
bis-
f
no
mp
bis- post hoc ex sil- i- um-
36
pp
no
mp
bis- post hoc ex sil- i- um- os ten
f
- de- no
p
bis- post hoc ex sil- i- um-
no
mp
bis- post hoc e
f
no
p
bis- post hoc ex sil- i- um-
p mf p
p mf p
6
4
6
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
5
4
3
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
5
4
3
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
5
4
3
4
4
4
6
4
4
4
3
4
4
4
5
4
3
4
4
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
3
4
&Solo Alto
&Soprano I
3
&Soprano II
∑ ∑
&Alto I
∑ ∑
&Alto II
∑ ∑
&
@ ?
&
@ ?
&
&
&
‹: ;
∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
>
?∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
&
@ ?
&
@ ?
&
&
@ ?
∑ ∑
&
‹: ;
?
œœ
œ œ ˙ œœ œ œ œ œ œ ˙
œœ œ ˙
˙ œ œ œœ œ œ w
œœ œ# œ œ œ# w
œ# œ# œ œœ# œ# œ œ ˙ ˙ œ œ# œ
˙ ˙ œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œœ œ
w
œ# œ œ œ œ# œ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ™ ˙ ˙ ™ w w
œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ™ ˙ ˙ ™ w w
œ œ œ œ# œ# œ œ œ œ œ# œ# œ ˙ ˙ ˙ ™ ˙ ˙ ™ w w
œœ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ œ œ# ˙ w#
œ#œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ#
w#
˙ Ó
œœ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œ ˙
œ#œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ#
w
œœ œ œ œ# œ# œ œ
œœ œ# œ
œœ œ# œ
œœ œ# œ œ œ# ˙ w# w
w
w w ˙
Ó
œœ ˙# w w
w
w ww#
w w w
œœ œ œ œ# œ# œ œ w ˙ Ó
œœ œ œ ˙# ˙ w
œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ# œ œ#
w#
œœ œ œ œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ œ ˙# ˙ w#
œ# œ œ œ œœ œ ˙
w ˙
Ó
œœ œ œ œ# œ œ œ ˙ ˙ w
œ œ œ œ œœ œ ˙
w w w ˙
Ó
˙˙ w
w<#> w w w w w ˙ ™ ˙ ™
w w w w w w ˙ ™ ˙ ™
2
134
°
¢
°
¢
no bis- post hoc ex sil- i- um- os ten- de- O cle mens- O pi a- O dul cis- Vir go- Ma ri
mf
- a-
44
no bis- post hoc ex sil- i- um- os ten- de- O cle mens- O pi a- O dul cis- Vir go- Ma ri
mf
- a-
no bis- post hoc ex sil- i- um- os ten- de- O cle mens- O pi a- O dul cis- Vir go- Ma ri
mf
- a-
O cle mens- O pi a- O dul cis- Vir go- Ma ri
mf
- a-
O cle mens- O pi a- O dul cis- Vir go- Ma ri
mf
- a-
O
mf
Sanc
p
ta- De i- gen i- trix- pro mis- si- on- i- bus- Chris ti
mf
-
54
Sanc
p
ta- De i- gen i- trix- pro mis- si- on- i- bus- Chris ti
mf
-
ah
p
ah Chris ti
mf
-
ah
p
ah Chris ti
mf
-
Or
mf
a- pro no bis- ut dig ni- ef fi- ca- mur- Chris ti
mf
-
Or
mf
a- pro no bis- ut dig ni- ef fi- ca- mur- Chris ti
mf
-
O
flessibile
ra- pro no bis- Sanc ta- de i- ge ni- trix- ut dig ni- ef fic- ca- mur- pro mis- si- on- i- bus- Chris ti-
62
6
4
3
4
5
4
4
4
3
2
6
4
3
4
5
4
4
4
3
2
6
4
3
4
5
4
4
4
3
2
6
4
3
4
5
4
4
4
3
2
6
4
3
4
5
4
4
4
3
2
6
4
3
4
5
4
4
4
3
2
3
2
4
4
7
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
7
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
7
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
7
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
7
4
4
4
3
2
4
4
7
4
4
4
4
4
&
3
&
3
&
3
&∑ ∑ ∑ ∑ ∑
3
&
‹: ;
3
?
&
3 3
U U
&
3
3 U U
&
U
&
U
&
‹: ;
U U
?U U
&Solo Alto
œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ# œ œ# œ# œ# œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ œ# œ# ˙ ˙œ# œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ# œ œ œ
w w#
œ# œ œ œ œœ œ ˙ œ# œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙# ˙ ˙
œ œ œœ# œ œ œ œ œ w w
œ œ œ œ œœ œ ˙ œ œ œ œ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ˙ ˙
œ# œ œœ œ œ œ# œ œ w# w
˙ ˙ ˙ œ œ œœ# œ œ œ œ œ w w
˙<#> ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ œ œ# œ# œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ œ w w
˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™˙ ™ w ™ ˙ ™ ˙ ™ ˙ w w
˙<#> ™ Ó™ Ó œ# œ œ œ œ# œ ˙ ˙ ™ ∑ Ó œ# œ œ œ œ# œ ˙ w ˙Ó
˙ ™ Ó™ Ó œ œ# œ œ œ œ# ˙ ˙ ™ ∑ Ó œ œ# œ œ œ œ ˙# w ˙ Ó
˙<#> ™Ó™ Ó
˙# w ˙ ™∑ Ó
˙# ˙# ˙ w# ˙Ó
˙ ™
Ó™ Ó
˙ w ˙ ™
∑ Ó
˙ ˙ ˙# w ˙
Ó
œœ œ# œ œ œ# w w
œœ œ# œ œ œ œ# w ˙ ˙
w ˙ Ó
œw ™œ œ# œ œ œ# w
w
w
w œwœ œ# œ œ
˙ ™œ œ# w
w
˙
˙
˙
˙
w ˙ Ó
œœ#
œ œ# ˙ œœ œ# œ œ œ œ ˙
œœ œ œ œ
œ ˙ œ œ œ œœ œ œ œ w
3
135
°
¢
A
p cresc.
men
f
- - - - - A
mp
men- A
p
men-
63
A
p cresc.
men
f
- - - - A
mp
men- A
p
men-
A
p cresc.
men
f
- - - - - A
mp
men- A
p
men-
A
mf
men
f
- A
mp
men- A
p
men-
A
p cresc.
fmp
men- - - - - - - - - - - - - A
p
men-
A
p cresc.
f
mp
men- - - - - - - - - - - - - A
p
men-
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
&
@ ?
U U U U U
&
@ ?
U U U U U
&
U U U U U
&∑
U U U U U
&
‹: ; @ ?
U U U U U
?U U U U U
œœ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ œ œ# œ w# w w# w# Œ w# w# w
Ó
œœ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ w w w w Œ w w w
œœ œ# œ
œœ œ œ
œœ œ# œ œ œ# œ w# w w# w#
Œw# w w
Ó
œœ œ# w w w# w#
Œ
w# w# w
w w
œœ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ œ œ œ# œ w w Œ w w w
w w œœ œ# œ
œœ œ œ œ œ# œ œ œ# œ œ w w#
Œ
w w w
4
136
Analysis
The piece consists of three sections, clearly divided by plainchant interludes. The opening
section (A) introduces the first melodic idea and its development as a canon, the second section
(B) introduces a second thematic idea and develops this together with the first. The third and
final section is a relatively brief coda using material from section A. The piece opens with the
well known plainchant melody:
Figure 7.1 Salve Regina: Plainchant Melody
The first five notes of this melody are then taken as the basis for the following variation which in
turn is the most significant motivic idea throughout the remainder of the piece:
Figure 7.2 Salve Regina: Motif derived from plainchant
The introduction of this idea is extended into a longer melodic line which mixes the major and
minor modes and is accompanied with a simple counterpoint.
Figure 7.3 Salve Regina: Two voice counterpoint
137
This idea is then taken as the basis for a canonic passage:
Figure 7.4 Salve Regina: Canonic development of motif A
This concludes section A, which is followed by a repeat of the plainchant melody, this time in
the minor mode. This shift of mode does not occur in the traditional melody. The following
section (B) begins with the same motif as section A but then immediately introduces new
material.
Figure 7.5 Salve Regina: Secondary material
138
This passage (at bar 22) can be analysed as follows:
A: I7 IV9 I7
The use of seventh and ninth chords introduces a harmonic language that is foreign to more
traditional forms of sacred choral music. 99
The following passage return to the canonic texture, which is repeated in the key of B minor.
This is the only change of tonality in the piece and is only briefly established before a return to
the key of A.
Figure 7.6 Salve Regina: Canonic passage in B minor
99 But not necessarily precluded by the aesthetic aims of the project, given that these harmonies are perfectly intelligible within traditional modal systems.
139
The conclusion of section B combines the two main melodic figures, the male voices taking one
and the sopranos the other, and the alto providing harmony.
Figure 7.7 Salve Regina: Alternating male-female voices
After another plainchant passage the final coda is heard, based on the original plainchant derived
motif.
Figure 7.8 Salve Regina: Coda
140
Conclusion
This project contained several inherent challenges that had to be continuously addressed
throughout the process. The first to arise was the problem of how to balance the two aspects of
the project; on the one hand the investigation and analysis of traditionalist literature, and on the
other using this to derive inspiration for the composition of new works and the actual
compositional phase itself. Given that the last of these is supposed to be the creative focus of the
project, it was necessary to avoid becoming mired in philosophical debates which were likely to
arise when addressing traditionalist literature, given the contentious nature of many of the ideas
in the context of modern academia. This problem was essentially solved simply by bypassing
these debates altogether. Rather than attempt to address these issues, the project simply takes the
traditionalist literature as a starting point from which to derive aesthetic principles and these in
turn inform the compositions. There is never any question of entering into the debate over the
fundamental ideas themselves, which would have constituted an entirely separate project. A
related difficulty was the problem of the project becoming more about creating technical and
theoretical systems in accordance with the traditionalist framework, which could have become a
distraction from the actual work of composing music. This problem was again bypassed by
simplifying the theoretical and technical aspect of the work. A temptation could have been to
attempt to create complex theories and means of applying them based on the work of Danielou,
for example, but this would have been unnecessary to achieve what the project set out to do,
which was to compose works informed by the aesthetic philosophy of the traditionalists. In fact
it would not really be in the spirit of the writings of Schuon, for example, to over-intellectualise
the compositional process. As such, when concepts such as tuning systems did arise, the
simplest solution was sought, in this case trying to avoid the use of instruments such as the piano
which is restricted to equal temperament and composing in such a way as to encourage the use of
natural intonation.
Given that the primary aim of the project was to compose works which expressed the aesthetic
ideals of the traditionalist school, how does one evaluate the success, or otherwise, of the work?
141
Some degree of subjectivity is inevitable here. On the one hand many of the pieces successfully
integrate several of Schuon’s key ideas, such as clarity of expression, elegance and the lack of
excess in dimensions of time and instrumentation. At other times there was a departure from
these concepts, particularly in Élivágar, without the spirit of contemplation or reverence ever
being considered of lesser importance. Some of the more musically successful moments in the
project, in my estimation, came as a result of these departures, whereas some of the less
satisfying moments were the result of an attempt to ‘intellectualise’ and create theoretical
techniques that expressed philosophical concepts in an abstract way. This in itself is a lesson,
that musical intuition is superior to excessive abstraction in determining the use to which to put
the various materials at the composers command.
The difficulties described above of this project have led to my being reluctant to seek to expand
it in any way. Attempting to forge a direct connection between philosophical ideas and music
was a greater challenge than originally anticipated. Nevertheless, there are a number of avenues
hinted at by this project which yet remain unexplored. The first of these is a further exploration
of how to derive a musical language from the aesthetic and metaphysical statements of the
traditionalists. In effect, this is what Alain Danielou did with his work, Introduction to the Study
of Musical Scales, however, this work only addresses the treatment of pitch, and only does so 100
in an abstract way and not with a view to how such scales may be used in the composition of
new works. Therefore there is significant room to do more work in this area.
In addition to this area there is room for expansion upon some of the musical ideas which arose
in the project. In particular the inclusion of counterpoint techniques derived from organum, as
well as the use of modes which extended beyond the octave, built from smaller units such as
tetrachords. Rhythmic features of organum also offer possibilities for further exploration. In
addition to this there remain possibilities of numerical symbolism and rhythmic relationships
which were present in Élivágar but which could be significantly elaborated in future works. At
the present time it is envisioned that my own direction will expand upon the stylistic approach
100 Danielou, op. cit.
142
featured in Élivágar. Despite this apparent departure from the ideas presented in this project, the
work of the traditionalists will remain the intellectual and spiritual inspiration of my work for the
foreseeable future.
143
List of Sources
Andrews, H.K, The Technique of Byrd’s Vocal Polyphony, (Oxford: Oxford University Press,
1966)
Apel, Willi, The Notation of Polyphonic Music , (Cambridge, Massachusetts: The Mediaeval
Academy of America, 1953)
Apel, Willi, ‘St. Martial to Notre-Dame,’ Journal of the American Musicological Society 2,
No. 3, 1949, pp. 145-158
Boulez, Pierre, ‘Where are we now?’ in Orientations , ed. Jean-Jaques Nattiez, (London: Faber
1986), transcript of a lecture entitled ‘ Où En Est-On?’ given in May 1968.
Burckhardt, Titus, The Essential Titus Burckhardt, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 2003)
Clarkson, Chris et al., ‘Human occupation of northern Australia by 65,000 years ago,’ Nature
547, (London: Macmillan 2017), pp. 306-310
Coomaraswamy, Ananda, The Essential Ananda Coomaraswamy, (Bloomington, Indiana: World
Wisdom, 2005)
Danielou, Alain, Music and the Power of Sound, (Rochester: Inner Traditions, 1995), originally
published as Introduction to the Study of Musical Scales, (Benares: Indian Press, 1943)
Duckles, Vincent & Pasler, Jann, ‘The Nature of Musicology,’ The New Grove Dictionary of
Music and Musicians 17, (London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 488-492
Fuller, Sarah, ‘Theoretical Foundations of Early Organum Theory,’ Acta Musicologica 53, No. 1
1981, pp. 52-84
Guenon, Rene, Introduction to the Study of Hindu Doctrines, trans. Marco Pallis, (London:
Luzac and Co., 1945)
Guenon, Rene, Theosophy: History of a Pseudo-Religion, (Hillsdale, New York: Sophia
Perennis, 2004, 1st edn. 1921)
Guenon, Rene, The Crisis of the Modern World, (Hillsdale, New York: Sophia Perennis, 2004,
1st edn. 1946)
144
Guinness , Os, The Dust of Death: A Critique of the Establishment and the Counter Culture and
the Proposal for a Third Way , (Downer’s Grove, Illinois: Intervarsity Press, 1973)
Hiley, David, Western Plainchant: A Handbook, (Oxford: Clarendon Press, 1993)
Iammarino, Darren, Cosmosyntheism: A Paradigm of Multiple Religious Ultimates for the 21st
Century , Doctoral Thesis, (Claremont, California: The Claremont Graduate University,
2010.)
Jacob, Jose, The Architectural Theory of Manasara, Doctoral Thesis, (Montreal: McGill
University, 2003)
Jenny, Herbert, ‘Perotin’s ‘Viderunt Omnes’,’ Bulletin of the American Musicological Society ,
No. 6, 1942, pp. 20-21
Lennart, Nils. Brown, Steven. Merker, Bjorn. Wallin, Christina (eds), The Origins of Music ,
(Cambridge, Massachusetts: MIT Press, 1999)
Lindley, Mark, ‘Equal Temperament,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 8,
(London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 275-276
Nathan, Hans, ‘Styles of Early Polyphony,’ Bulletin of the American Musicological Society ,
No. 4, 1930, pp. 32-33
Nidel, Richard, World Music: The Basics , (New York: Routledge, 2005)
Plato, The Republic in Strunk/Treitler, Source Readings in Music History , (New York: W.W.
Norton and Company Inc., 1951)
Potter, Keith, ‘Minimalism,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 16, (London:
Macmillan, 2001), pp. 716-718
Powers, Harold S., ‘India: Theory and Practice of Classical Music,’ The New Grove Dictionary
of Music and Musicians 12, (London: Macmillan 2001), pp. 178-188
Randel, Don Michael, The Harvard Dictionary of Music , (Cambridge, Massachusetts: Harvard
University Press, 1986)
Roesner, Edward, ‘Performance of Parisian Organum,’ Early Music 7, No. 2, 1979, pp. 174-189
Sanders, Ernest, ‘Consonance and Rhythm in the Organum of the 12th and 13th Centuries,’
Journal of the American Musicological Society 33, No. 2, 1980, pp. 264-286
145
Schuon, Frithjof, From the Divine to the Human, trans. Mark Perry, Jean-Pierre Lafouge,
(Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 2013, p. 127, 1st edn., 1981)
Schuon, Frithjof, Language of the Self, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 1999, p. 19, 1st
edn., 1959)
Schuon, Frithjof, Light on the Ancient Worlds, trans. Deborah Casey, Mark Perry, Jean-Pierre
Lafouge, James Cutsinger, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 2006)
Schuon, Frithjof, The Transcendent Unity of Religions, (Wheaton: Quest Books,
2005, 1st edn., 1953)
Schuon, Frithjof, Spiritual Perspectives and Human Facts, trans. Mark Perry, Jean-Pierre
Lafouge, James Cutsinger, (Bloomington, Indiana: World Wisdom, 2007)
Scott, Samuel H. & Soderlund, Gustave Fredric, Examples of Gregorian Chant and Other Sacred
Music of the 16th Century, (New York: Appleton-Century-Crofts, 1971)
Stolba, Marie K., The Development of Western Music: A History, (New York: McGraw Hill,
1998.)
Strickland, Edward, ‘Riley, Terry,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 21,
(London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 395-396
Thurston, Ethel, The Works of Perotin , (New York: Edwin F. Kalmus, 1970)
Waite, William, The Rhythm of 12th Century Polyphony , (Westport, Connecticut: Greenwood
Press Publishers, 1976)
Waite, William, ‘Discantus, Copula, Organum,’ Journal of the American Musicological Society
5, No. 2, 1952, pp. 77-87
Webster, James, ‘Sonata Form,’ The New Grove Dictionary of Music and Musicians 23,
(London: Macmillan, 2001), pp. 687-701
Yudkin, Jeremy, ‘The Rhythm of Organum Purum,’ The Journal of Musicology 2, No. 4, 1983,
pp. 355-376.
146
Online
Cage, John, ‘John Cage: An Autobiographical Statement,’ 1990,
http://johncage.org/autobiographical_statement.html [accessed 21 August 2016]
Coomaraswamy, Ananda, ‘The Nature of Medieval Art,’ Studies in Comparative Religiom 15 ,
Nos. 1 & 2, 1983,
http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/public/articles/The_Nature_of_Medieval_
Art-by_Ananda_K_Coomaraswamy.aspx [accessed 24 August 2016]
Fabbri, Renaud, ‘Introduction to the Perennialist School,’ Religio Perennis
http://religioperennis.org/documents/Fabbri/Perennialism.pdf [accessed 21 August
2016].
Godwin, Joscelyn, ‘Spiritual Currents in Music,’ Studies in Comparative Religion 5,
No. 2, 1971,
http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/Public/articles/Spiritual_Currents_in_Musi
c-by_Joscelyn_Godwin.aspx [accessed 24 August 2016]
Guenon, Rene, ‘The Arts and Their Traditional Conception,’ Studies in Comparative Religion
14, Nos. 3 & 4, 1980,
http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/Public/articles/The_Arts_and_their_Traditional_C
onception-by_Ren%C3%A9_Gu%C3%A9non.aspx [accessed 24 August 2016]
Legenhausen, Muhammad, ‘Why I am not a Traditionalist,’ 2002,
http://www.religioscope.com/info/doc/esotrad/legenhausen.htm [accessed 7 October
2016].
Li Ji, trans. James Legge, https://ctext.org/liji [accessed 11 May 2018]
Nasr, Seyyed Hossein, ‘Islam and Music,’ Studies in Comparative Religion 10, No. 1, 1976,
http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/public/articles/Islam_and_Music-by_Seyy
ed_Hossein_Nasr.aspx [accessed 24 August 2016]
147
Nasr, Seyyed Hossein, ‘The Influence of Sufism on Traditional Persian Music,’
Studies in Comparative Religion 6, No. 4, 1972,
http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/public/articles/Islam_and_Music-by_Seyy
ed_Hossein_Nasr.aspx [accessed 24 August 2016]
Oldmeadow, Harry, ‘Ananda Coomaraswamy’s Life and Work,’ 2004,
http://www.worldwisdom.com/public/authors/Ananda-K-Coomaraswamy.aspx [accessed
21 August 2016]
Oldmeadow, Harry, ‘Rene Guenon’s Life and Work,’ 2005,
http://www.worldwisdom.com/public/authors/Rene-Guenon.aspx#_edn1 [accessed 21
August 2016]
Pallis, Marco, ‘Metaphysics of Musical Polyphony,’ Studies in Comparative Religion 10,
No. 2, 1976,
http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/Public/articles/Metaphysics_of_Musical_P
olyphony-by_Marco_Pallis.aspx [accessed 24 August 2016]
Plato, The Symposium , trans. Benjamin Jowett,
http://classics.mit.edu/Plato/symposium.html accessed [22 August 2016]
Reilly, Robert, ‘The Music of the Spheres,’ 2001,
http://www.theimaginativeconservative.org/2012/02/music-of-spheres.html [accessed 18
May 2018]
Schidmt-Leukel, Perry, ‘Pluralist Theologies,’ The Expository Times 122, 2010,
http://www.sacredweb.com/online_articles/sw11_reilly.pdf [accessed 24 August 2016]
Schuon, Frithjof, ‘Foundations of an Integral Aesthetics,’ Studies in Comparative Religion 10,
No. 3, 1976, http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/uploads/ArticlePDFs/291.pdf
[accessed 24 August 2016]
Schuon, Frithjof, ‘The Degrees of Art,’ Studies in Comparative Religion 10, No. 4, 1976,
http://www.studiesincomparativereligion.com/Public/articles/The_Degrees_of_Art-by_Fr
ithjof_Schuon.aspx [accessed 24 August 2016]
148
Scott, Timothy, ‘A Brief Introduction to the ‘Traditional Doctrine of Art’,’ in T. Scott and
R. Fabbri (eds), Vincint Omnia Veritas Collected Essays , 2010,
http://timothyscott.com.au/Assets/pdfs/VincitOmniaVeritas.pdf , [accessed 24 August
2016]
Segura, Jose, ‘A Traditional Critique of Humanist Art,’
http://www.sacredweb.com/online_articles/sw3_segura.html [accessed 24 August 2016]
The Liber Usualis , Church Music Association of America, 1961,
http://www.sanctamissa.org/en/music/gregorian-chant/choir/liber-usualis-1961.pdf
[accessed 08 March 2017]
White, Michael, ‘Christian Composer Inspired by Allah’s 99 Names,’ New York Times, 17 June
2007,
http://www.nytimes.com/2007/06/17/arts/music/17whit.html?_r=3&oref=slogin&ref=mu
sic&pagewanted=print& [accessed 24 August 2016]
149
Audio Recordings
Burzum, Hvis Lyset Tar Oss , (Hadleigh, Suffolk: Misanthropy Records, 1994)
Emperor, In the Nightside Eclipse , (Wallingford, Oxfordshire: Candlelight Records, 1994)
Gorgoroth, Pentagram , (Amiens, Hauts-de-France: Embassy Productions, 1994)
Hillier, Paul & The Hilliard Ensemble, Perotin , (Munich: ECM Records, 1988)
Hillier, Paul & Theatre of Voices, The Age of Cathedrals , (Arles, Bouche-du-Rhone: Harmonia
Mundi, 1996)
Leeuwen, Ger Van & Singers of the Amsterdamn Synagogue, Jewish Sacred Songs , (Baarn,
Netherlands: Philips, 1987)
Peres, Marcel & Ensemble Organum, Messe de Notre Dame , (Arles, Bouche-du-Rhone:
Harmonia Mundi, 1996)
Shankar, Ravi, Music of India , (London:Not Now Music, 2013)
Various, The Music of Islam , (Tuscon, Arizona: Celestial Harmonies, 1998)
150